Bug 1435212 - Add support for FFmpeg 4.0. r=bryce
authorJean-Yves Avenard <jyavenard@mozilla.com>
Thu, 19 Apr 2018 10:19:15 +0200
changeset 468017 573a198b7fdf076e27eb1f468162df101246d7b3
parent 468016 b0c68c17915159517e82c04b26801ff3869f61be
child 468018 9c246c15f12a2eb0ed20188b2c8c504baf5f1aec
push id9165
push userasasaki@mozilla.com
push dateThu, 26 Apr 2018 21:04:54 +0000
treeherdermozilla-beta@064c3804de2e [default view] [failures only]
perfherder[talos] [build metrics] [platform microbench] (compared to previous push)
reviewersbryce
bugs1435212
milestone61.0a1
first release with
nightly linux32
nightly linux64
nightly mac
nightly win32
nightly win64
last release without
nightly linux32
nightly linux64
nightly mac
nightly win32
nightly win64
Bug 1435212 - Add support for FFmpeg 4.0. r=bryce MozReview-Commit-ID: JlDFSUyGQu
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegDataDecoder.cpp
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegLibWrapper.cpp
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegLibs.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegRuntimeLinker.cpp
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegVideoDecoder.cpp
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/COPYING.LGPLv2.1
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/avcodec.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/avfft.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/vaapi.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/vdpau.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/version.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/attributes.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/avconfig.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/avutil.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/buffer.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/channel_layout.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/common.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/cpu.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/dict.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/error.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/frame.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/hwcontext.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/intfloat.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/log.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/macros.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/mathematics.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/mem.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/pixfmt.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/rational.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/samplefmt.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/version.h
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/moz.build
dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/moz.build
--- a/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegDataDecoder.cpp
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegDataDecoder.cpp
@@ -72,25 +72,31 @@ FFmpegDataDecoder<LIBAV_VER>::InitDecode
   mCodecContext->opaque = this;
 
   InitCodecContext();
 
   if (mExtraData) {
     mCodecContext->extradata_size = mExtraData->Length();
     // FFmpeg may use SIMD instructions to access the data which reads the
     // data in 32 bytes block. Must ensure we have enough data to read.
+#if LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR >= 58
+    mExtraData->AppendElements(AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE);
+#else
     mExtraData->AppendElements(FF_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE);
+#endif
     mCodecContext->extradata = mExtraData->Elements();
   } else {
     mCodecContext->extradata_size = 0;
   }
 
+#if LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 57
   if (codec->capabilities & CODEC_CAP_DR1) {
     mCodecContext->flags |= CODEC_FLAG_EMU_EDGE;
   }
+#endif
 
   if (mLib->avcodec_open2(mCodecContext, codec, nullptr) < 0) {
     mLib->avcodec_close(mCodecContext);
     mLib->av_freep(&mCodecContext);
     return MediaResult(NS_ERROR_DOM_MEDIA_FATAL_ERR,
                        RESULT_DETAIL("Couldn't initialise ffmpeg decoder"));
   }
 
--- a/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegLibWrapper.cpp
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegLibWrapper.cpp
@@ -58,22 +58,24 @@ FFmpegLibWrapper::Link()
 
   enum {
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK = 1 << 8,
     AV_FUNC_53 = 1 << 0,
     AV_FUNC_54 = 1 << 1,
     AV_FUNC_55 = 1 << 2,
     AV_FUNC_56 = 1 << 3,
     AV_FUNC_57 = 1 << 4,
+    AV_FUNC_58 = 1 << 5,
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_53 = AV_FUNC_53 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK,
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_54 = AV_FUNC_54 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK,
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 = AV_FUNC_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK,
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 = AV_FUNC_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK,
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57 = AV_FUNC_57 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK,
-    AV_FUNC_AVCODEC_ALL = AV_FUNC_53 | AV_FUNC_54 | AV_FUNC_55 | AV_FUNC_56 | AV_FUNC_57,
+    AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_58 = AV_FUNC_58 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK,
+    AV_FUNC_AVCODEC_ALL = AV_FUNC_53 | AV_FUNC_54 | AV_FUNC_55 | AV_FUNC_56 | AV_FUNC_57 | AV_FUNC_58,
     AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_ALL = AV_FUNC_AVCODEC_ALL | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_MASK
   };
 
   switch (macro) {
     case 53:
       version = AV_FUNC_53;
       break;
     case 54:
@@ -83,16 +85,19 @@ FFmpegLibWrapper::Link()
       version = AV_FUNC_55;
       break;
     case 56:
       version = AV_FUNC_56;
       break;
     case 57:
       version = AV_FUNC_57;
       break;
+    case 58:
+      version = AV_FUNC_58;
+      break;
     default:
       FFMPEG_LOG("Unknown avcodec version");
       Unlink();
       return isFFMpeg
              ? ((macro > 57)
                 ? LinkResult::UnknownFutureFFMpegVersion
                 : LinkResult::UnknownOlderFFMpegVersion)
              // All LibAV versions<54.35.1 are blocked, therefore we must be
@@ -131,19 +136,19 @@ FFmpegLibWrapper::Link()
   AV_FUNC(av_parser_close, AV_FUNC_AVCODEC_ALL)
   AV_FUNC(av_parser_parse2, AV_FUNC_AVCODEC_ALL)
   AV_FUNC(avcodec_alloc_frame, (AV_FUNC_53 | AV_FUNC_54))
   AV_FUNC(avcodec_get_frame_defaults, (AV_FUNC_53 | AV_FUNC_54))
   AV_FUNC(avcodec_free_frame, AV_FUNC_54)
   AV_FUNC(av_log_set_level, AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_ALL)
   AV_FUNC(av_malloc, AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_ALL)
   AV_FUNC(av_freep, AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_ALL)
-  AV_FUNC(av_frame_alloc, (AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57))
-  AV_FUNC(av_frame_free, (AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57))
-  AV_FUNC(av_frame_unref, (AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57))
+  AV_FUNC(av_frame_alloc, (AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_58))
+  AV_FUNC(av_frame_free, (AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_58))
+  AV_FUNC(av_frame_unref, (AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_55 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_56 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_57 | AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_58))
   AV_FUNC_OPTION(av_frame_get_colorspace, AV_FUNC_AVUTIL_ALL)
 #undef AV_FUNC
 #undef AV_FUNC_OPTION
 
   avcodec_register_all();
   if (MOZ_LOG_TEST(sPDMLog, LogLevel::Debug)) {
     av_log_set_level(AV_LOG_DEBUG);
   } else if (MOZ_LOG_TEST(sPDMLog, LogLevel::Info)) {
--- a/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegLibs.h
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegLibs.h
@@ -22,18 +22,20 @@ extern "C" {
 #if LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 55
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_VP6F CODEC_ID_VP6F
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_H264 CODEC_ID_H264
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_AAC CODEC_ID_AAC
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_MP3 CODEC_ID_MP3
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_VP8 CODEC_ID_VP8
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_NONE CODEC_ID_NONE
 #define AV_CODEC_ID_FLAC CODEC_ID_FLAC
+typedef CodecID AVCodecID;
+#endif
+#if LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR <= 55
 #define AV_CODEC_FLAG_LOW_DELAY CODEC_FLAG_LOW_DELAY
-typedef CodecID AVCodecID;
 #endif
 
 #ifdef FFVPX_VERSION
 enum { LIBAV_VER = FFVPX_VERSION };
 #else
 enum { LIBAV_VER = LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR };
 #endif
 
--- a/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegRuntimeLinker.cpp
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegRuntimeLinker.cpp
@@ -21,22 +21,25 @@ template <int V> class FFmpegDecoderModu
 public:
   static already_AddRefed<PlatformDecoderModule> Create(FFmpegLibWrapper*);
 };
 
 static FFmpegLibWrapper sLibAV;
 
 static const char* sLibs[] = {
 #if defined(XP_DARWIN)
+  "libavcodec.58.dylib",
   "libavcodec.57.dylib",
   "libavcodec.56.dylib",
   "libavcodec.55.dylib",
   "libavcodec.54.dylib",
   "libavcodec.53.dylib",
 #else
+  "libavcodec.so.58",
+  "libavcodec-ffmpeg.so.58",
   "libavcodec-ffmpeg.so.57",
   "libavcodec-ffmpeg.so.56",
   "libavcodec.so.57",
   "libavcodec.so.56",
   "libavcodec.so.55",
   "libavcodec.so.54",
   "libavcodec.so.53",
 #endif
@@ -129,16 +132,17 @@ FFmpegRuntimeLinker::CreateDecoderModule
   }
   RefPtr<PlatformDecoderModule> module;
   switch (sLibAV.mVersion) {
     case 53: module = FFmpegDecoderModule<53>::Create(&sLibAV); break;
     case 54: module = FFmpegDecoderModule<54>::Create(&sLibAV); break;
     case 55:
     case 56: module = FFmpegDecoderModule<55>::Create(&sLibAV); break;
     case 57: module = FFmpegDecoderModule<57>::Create(&sLibAV); break;
+    case 58: module = FFmpegDecoderModule<58>::Create(&sLibAV); break;
     default: module = nullptr;
   }
   return module.forget();
 }
 
 /* static */ const char*
 FFmpegRuntimeLinker::LinkStatusString()
 {
--- a/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegVideoDecoder.cpp
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/FFmpegVideoDecoder.cpp
@@ -161,17 +161,17 @@ FFmpegVideoDecoder<LIBAV_VER>::InitCodec
     decode_threads = 8;
   } else if (mInfo.mDisplay.width >= 1024) {
     decode_threads = 4;
   } else if (mInfo.mDisplay.width >= 320) {
     decode_threads = 2;
   }
 
   if (mLowLatency) {
-    mCodecContext->flags |= CODEC_FLAG_LOW_DELAY;
+    mCodecContext->flags |= AV_CODEC_FLAG_LOW_DELAY;
     // ffvp9 and ffvp8 at this stage do not support slice threading, but it may
     // help with the h264 decoder if there's ever one.
     mCodecContext->thread_type = FF_THREAD_SLICE;
   } else {
     decode_threads = std::min(decode_threads, PR_GetNumberOfProcessors() - 1);
     decode_threads = std::max(decode_threads, 1);
     mCodecContext->thread_count = decode_threads;
     if (decode_threads > 1) {
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/COPYING.LGPLv2.1
@@ -0,0 +1,504 @@
+                  GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+                       Version 2.1, February 1999
+
+ Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+ of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+
+[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL.  It also counts
+ as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence
+ the version number 2.1.]
+
+                            Preamble
+
+  The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
+freedom to share and change it.  By contrast, the GNU General Public
+Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change
+free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users.
+
+  This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some
+specially designated software packages--typically libraries--of the
+Free Software Foundation and other authors who decide to use it.  You
+can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully about whether
+this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better
+strategy to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
+
+  When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use,
+not price.  Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that
+you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge
+for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get
+it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of
+it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do
+these things.
+
+  To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
+distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender these
+rights.  These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for
+you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
+
+  For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis
+or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave
+you.  You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source
+code.  If you link other code with the library, you must provide
+complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them
+with the library after making changes to the library and recompiling
+it.  And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
+
+  We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the
+library, and (2) we offer you this license, which gives you legal
+permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library.
+
+  To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that
+there is no warranty for the free library.  Also, if the library is
+modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should know
+that what they have is not the original version, so that the original
+author's reputation will not be affected by problems that might be
+introduced by others.
+
+  Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of
+any free program.  We wish to make sure that a company cannot
+effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a
+restrictive license from a patent holder.  Therefore, we insist that
+any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be
+consistent with the full freedom of use specified in this license.
+
+  Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the
+ordinary GNU General Public License.  This license, the GNU Lesser
+General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries, and
+is quite different from the ordinary General Public License.  We use
+this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those
+libraries into non-free programs.
+
+  When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using
+a shared library, the combination of the two is legally speaking a
+combined work, a derivative of the original library.  The ordinary
+General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the
+entire combination fits its criteria of freedom.  The Lesser General
+Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with
+the library.
+
+  We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License because it
+does Less to protect the user's freedom than the ordinary General
+Public License.  It also provides other free software developers Less
+of an advantage over competing non-free programs.  These disadvantages
+are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many
+libraries.  However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain
+special circumstances.
+
+  For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to
+encourage the widest possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes
+a de-facto standard.  To achieve this, non-free programs must be
+allowed to use the library.  A more frequent case is that a free
+library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries.  In this
+case, there is little to gain by limiting the free library to free
+software only, so we use the Lesser General Public License.
+
+  In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free
+programs enables a greater number of people to use a large body of
+free software.  For example, permission to use the GNU C Library in
+non-free programs enables many more people to use the whole GNU
+operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating
+system.
+
+  Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the
+users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is
+linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run
+that program using a modified version of the Library.
+
+  The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
+modification follow.  Pay close attention to the difference between a
+"work based on the library" and a "work that uses the library".  The
+former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter must
+be combined with the library in order to run.
+
+                  GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+   TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
+
+  0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other
+program which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or
+other authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of
+this Lesser General Public License (also called "this License").
+Each licensee is addressed as "you".
+
+  A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data
+prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs
+(which use some of those functions and data) to form executables.
+
+  The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work
+which has been distributed under these terms.  A "work based on the
+Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under
+copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a
+portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated
+straightforwardly into another language.  (Hereinafter, translation is
+included without limitation in the term "modification".)
+
+  "Source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for
+making modifications to it.  For a library, complete source code means
+all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated
+interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation
+and installation of the library.
+
+  Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
+covered by this License; they are outside its scope.  The act of
+running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from
+such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based
+on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for
+writing it).  Whether that is true depends on what the Library does
+and what the program that uses the Library does.
+
+  1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library's
+complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that
+you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an
+appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
+all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any
+warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the
+Library.
+
+  You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy,
+and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a
+fee.
+
+  2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion
+of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and
+distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
+above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
+
+    a) The modified work must itself be a software library.
+
+    b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices
+    stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
+
+    c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no
+    charge to all third parties under the terms of this License.
+
+    d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a
+    table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses
+    the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility
+    is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that,
+    in the event an application does not supply such function or
+    table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of
+    its purpose remains meaningful.
+
+    (For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has
+    a purpose that is entirely well-defined independent of the
+    application.  Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any
+    application-supplied function or table used by this function must
+    be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square
+    root function must still compute square roots.)
+
+These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole.  If
+identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library,
+and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
+themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
+sections when you distribute them as separate works.  But when you
+distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
+on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
+this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
+entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote
+it.
+
+Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
+your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
+exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
+collective works based on the Library.
+
+In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library
+with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of
+a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
+the scope of this License.
+
+  3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public
+License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library.  To do
+this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so
+that they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2,
+instead of to this License.  (If a newer version than version 2 of the
+ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify
+that version instead if you wish.)  Do not make any other change in
+these notices.
+
+  Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for
+that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all
+subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy.
+
+  This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of
+the Library into a program that is not a library.
+
+  4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
+derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form
+under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany
+it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which
+must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a
+medium customarily used for software interchange.
+
+  If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy
+from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the
+source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to
+distribute the source code, even though third parties are not
+compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
+
+  5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the
+Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or
+linked with it, is called a "work that uses the Library".  Such a
+work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and
+therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
+
+  However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the Library
+creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it
+contains portions of the Library), rather than a "work that uses the
+library".  The executable is therefore covered by this License.
+Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables.
+
+  When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file
+that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a
+derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not.
+Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be
+linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library.  The
+threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law.
+
+  If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data
+structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline
+functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object
+file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
+work.  (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the
+Library will still fall under Section 6.)
+
+  Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may
+distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6.
+Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6,
+whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
+
+  6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or
+link a "work that uses the Library" with the Library to produce a
+work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work
+under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit
+modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse
+engineering for debugging such modifications.
+
+  You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the
+Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by
+this License.  You must supply a copy of this License.  If the work
+during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the
+copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference
+directing the user to the copy of this License.  Also, you must do one
+of these things:
+
+    a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding
+    machine-readable source code for the Library including whatever
+    changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under
+    Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked
+    with the Library, with the complete machine-readable "work that
+    uses the Library", as object code and/or source code, so that the
+    user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified
+    executable containing the modified Library.  (It is understood
+    that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the
+    Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application
+    to use the modified definitions.)
+
+    b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the
+    Library.  A suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a
+    copy of the library already present on the user's computer system,
+    rather than copying library functions into the executable, and (2)
+    will operate properly with a modified version of the library, if
+    the user installs one, as long as the modified version is
+    interface-compatible with the version that the work was made with.
+
+    c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at
+    least three years, to give the same user the materials
+    specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more
+    than the cost of performing this distribution.
+
+    d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy
+    from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above
+    specified materials from the same place.
+
+    e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these
+    materials or that you have already sent this user a copy.
+
+  For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the
+Library" must include any data and utility programs needed for
+reproducing the executable from it.  However, as a special exception,
+the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is
+normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major
+components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on
+which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies
+the executable.
+
+  It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license
+restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally
+accompany the operating system.  Such a contradiction means you cannot
+use both them and the Library together in an executable that you
+distribute.
+
+  7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the
+Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library
+facilities not covered by this License, and distribute such a combined
+library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on
+the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise
+permitted, and provided that you do these two things:
+
+    a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work
+    based on the Library, uncombined with any other library
+    facilities.  This must be distributed under the terms of the
+    Sections above.
+
+    b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact
+    that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining
+    where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
+
+  8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute
+the Library except as expressly provided under this License.  Any
+attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
+distribute the Library is void, and will automatically terminate your
+rights under this License.  However, parties who have received copies,
+or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses
+terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
+
+  9. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
+signed it.  However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
+distribute the Library or its derivative works.  These actions are
+prohibited by law if you do not accept this License.  Therefore, by
+modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on the
+Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
+all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
+the Library or works based on it.
+
+  10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the
+Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
+original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library
+subject to these terms and conditions.  You may not impose any further
+restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
+You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with
+this License.
+
+  11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
+infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
+conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
+otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
+excuse you from the conditions of this License.  If you cannot
+distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
+License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
+may not distribute the Library at all.  For example, if a patent
+license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by
+all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
+the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
+refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.
+
+If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any
+particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply,
+and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances.
+
+It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
+patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
+such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
+integrity of the free software distribution system which is
+implemented by public license practices.  Many people have made
+generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
+through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
+system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
+to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
+impose that choice.
+
+This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
+be a consequence of the rest of this License.
+
+  12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in
+certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
+original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add
+an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries,
+so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus
+excluded.  In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if
+written in the body of this License.
+
+  13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new
+versions of the Lesser General Public License from time to time.
+Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version,
+but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
+
+Each version is given a distinguishing version number.  If the Library
+specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and
+"any later version", you have the option of following the terms and
+conditions either of that version or of any later version published by
+the Free Software Foundation.  If the Library does not specify a
+license version number, you may choose any version ever published by
+the Free Software Foundation.
+
+  14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free
+programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these,
+write to the author to ask for permission.  For software which is
+copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free
+Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.  Our
+decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
+of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing
+and reuse of software generally.
+
+                            NO WARRANTY
+
+  15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
+WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
+EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR
+OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
+KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
+PURPOSE.  THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
+LIBRARY IS WITH YOU.  SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
+THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
+
+  16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
+WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY
+AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU
+FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
+CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
+LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
+RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
+FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF
+SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGES.
+
+                     END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
+
+           How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
+
+  If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest
+possible use to the public, we recommend making it free software that
+everyone can redistribute and change.  You can do so by permitting
+redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the
+ordinary General Public License).
+
+  To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library.  It is
+safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
+convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the
+"copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
+
+    <one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
+    Copyright (C) <year>  <name of author>
+
+    This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+    modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+    version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+    This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+    Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+    License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+
+Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
+
+You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
+school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the library, if
+necessary.  Here is a sample; alter the names:
+
+  Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the
+  library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
+
+  <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990
+  Ty Coon, President of Vice
+
+That's all there is to it!
+
+
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/avcodec.h
@@ -0,0 +1,6146 @@
+/*
+ * copyright (c) 2001 Fabrice Bellard
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVCODEC_AVCODEC_H
+#define AVCODEC_AVCODEC_H
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup libavc
+ * Libavcodec external API header
+ */
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#include "libavutil/samplefmt.h"
+#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
+#include "libavutil/avutil.h"
+#include "libavutil/buffer.h"
+#include "libavutil/cpu.h"
+#include "libavutil/channel_layout.h"
+#include "libavutil/dict.h"
+#include "libavutil/frame.h"
+#include "libavutil/hwcontext.h"
+#include "libavutil/log.h"
+#include "libavutil/pixfmt.h"
+#include "libavutil/rational.h"
+
+#include "version.h"
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup libavc libavcodec
+ * Encoding/Decoding Library
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavc_decoding Decoding
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavc_encoding Encoding
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavc_codec Codecs
+ * @{
+ * @defgroup lavc_codec_native Native Codecs
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ * @defgroup lavc_codec_wrappers External library wrappers
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ * @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel Hardware Accelerators bridge
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ * @}
+ * @defgroup lavc_internal Internal
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @ingroup libavc
+ * @defgroup lavc_encdec send/receive encoding and decoding API overview
+ * @{
+ *
+ * The avcodec_send_packet()/avcodec_receive_frame()/avcodec_send_frame()/
+ * avcodec_receive_packet() functions provide an encode/decode API, which
+ * decouples input and output.
+ *
+ * The API is very similar for encoding/decoding and audio/video, and works as
+ * follows:
+ * - Set up and open the AVCodecContext as usual.
+ * - Send valid input:
+ *   - For decoding, call avcodec_send_packet() to give the decoder raw
+ *     compressed data in an AVPacket.
+ *   - For encoding, call avcodec_send_frame() to give the encoder an AVFrame
+ *     containing uncompressed audio or video.
+ *   In both cases, it is recommended that AVPackets and AVFrames are
+ *   refcounted, or libavcodec might have to copy the input data. (libavformat
+ *   always returns refcounted AVPackets, and av_frame_get_buffer() allocates
+ *   refcounted AVFrames.)
+ * - Receive output in a loop. Periodically call one of the avcodec_receive_*()
+ *   functions and process their output:
+ *   - For decoding, call avcodec_receive_frame(). On success, it will return
+ *     an AVFrame containing uncompressed audio or video data.
+ *   - For encoding, call avcodec_receive_packet(). On success, it will return
+ *     an AVPacket with a compressed frame.
+ *   Repeat this call until it returns AVERROR(EAGAIN) or an error. The
+ *   AVERROR(EAGAIN) return value means that new input data is required to
+ *   return new output. In this case, continue with sending input. For each
+ *   input frame/packet, the codec will typically return 1 output frame/packet,
+ *   but it can also be 0 or more than 1.
+ *
+ * At the beginning of decoding or encoding, the codec might accept multiple
+ * input frames/packets without returning a frame, until its internal buffers
+ * are filled. This situation is handled transparently if you follow the steps
+ * outlined above.
+ *
+ * In theory, sending input can result in EAGAIN - this should happen only if
+ * not all output was received. You can use this to structure alternative decode
+ * or encode loops other than the one suggested above. For example, you could
+ * try sending new input on each iteration, and try to receive output if that
+ * returns EAGAIN.
+ *
+ * End of stream situations. These require "flushing" (aka draining) the codec,
+ * as the codec might buffer multiple frames or packets internally for
+ * performance or out of necessity (consider B-frames).
+ * This is handled as follows:
+ * - Instead of valid input, send NULL to the avcodec_send_packet() (decoding)
+ *   or avcodec_send_frame() (encoding) functions. This will enter draining
+ *   mode.
+ * - Call avcodec_receive_frame() (decoding) or avcodec_receive_packet()
+ *   (encoding) in a loop until AVERROR_EOF is returned. The functions will
+ *   not return AVERROR(EAGAIN), unless you forgot to enter draining mode.
+ * - Before decoding can be resumed again, the codec has to be reset with
+ *   avcodec_flush_buffers().
+ *
+ * Using the API as outlined above is highly recommended. But it is also
+ * possible to call functions outside of this rigid schema. For example, you can
+ * call avcodec_send_packet() repeatedly without calling
+ * avcodec_receive_frame(). In this case, avcodec_send_packet() will succeed
+ * until the codec's internal buffer has been filled up (which is typically of
+ * size 1 per output frame, after initial input), and then reject input with
+ * AVERROR(EAGAIN). Once it starts rejecting input, you have no choice but to
+ * read at least some output.
+ *
+ * Not all codecs will follow a rigid and predictable dataflow; the only
+ * guarantee is that an AVERROR(EAGAIN) return value on a send/receive call on
+ * one end implies that a receive/send call on the other end will succeed, or
+ * at least will not fail with AVERROR(EAGAIN). In general, no codec will
+ * permit unlimited buffering of input or output.
+ *
+ * This API replaces the following legacy functions:
+ * - avcodec_decode_video2() and avcodec_decode_audio4():
+ *   Use avcodec_send_packet() to feed input to the decoder, then use
+ *   avcodec_receive_frame() to receive decoded frames after each packet.
+ *   Unlike with the old video decoding API, multiple frames might result from
+ *   a packet. For audio, splitting the input packet into frames by partially
+ *   decoding packets becomes transparent to the API user. You never need to
+ *   feed an AVPacket to the API twice (unless it is rejected with AVERROR(EAGAIN) - then
+ *   no data was read from the packet).
+ *   Additionally, sending a flush/draining packet is required only once.
+ * - avcodec_encode_video2()/avcodec_encode_audio2():
+ *   Use avcodec_send_frame() to feed input to the encoder, then use
+ *   avcodec_receive_packet() to receive encoded packets.
+ *   Providing user-allocated buffers for avcodec_receive_packet() is not
+ *   possible.
+ * - The new API does not handle subtitles yet.
+ *
+ * Mixing new and old function calls on the same AVCodecContext is not allowed,
+ * and will result in undefined behavior.
+ *
+ * Some codecs might require using the new API; using the old API will return
+ * an error when calling it. All codecs support the new API.
+ *
+ * A codec is not allowed to return AVERROR(EAGAIN) for both sending and receiving. This
+ * would be an invalid state, which could put the codec user into an endless
+ * loop. The API has no concept of time either: it cannot happen that trying to
+ * do avcodec_send_packet() results in AVERROR(EAGAIN), but a repeated call 1 second
+ * later accepts the packet (with no other receive/flush API calls involved).
+ * The API is a strict state machine, and the passage of time is not supposed
+ * to influence it. Some timing-dependent behavior might still be deemed
+ * acceptable in certain cases. But it must never result in both send/receive
+ * returning EAGAIN at the same time at any point. It must also absolutely be
+ * avoided that the current state is "unstable" and can "flip-flop" between
+ * the send/receive APIs allowing progress. For example, it's not allowed that
+ * the codec randomly decides that it actually wants to consume a packet now
+ * instead of returning a frame, after it just returned AVERROR(EAGAIN) on an
+ * avcodec_send_packet() call.
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_core Core functions/structures.
+ * @ingroup libavc
+ *
+ * Basic definitions, functions for querying libavcodec capabilities,
+ * allocating core structures, etc.
+ * @{
+ */
+
+
+/**
+ * Identify the syntax and semantics of the bitstream.
+ * The principle is roughly:
+ * Two decoders with the same ID can decode the same streams.
+ * Two encoders with the same ID can encode compatible streams.
+ * There may be slight deviations from the principle due to implementation
+ * details.
+ *
+ * If you add a codec ID to this list, add it so that
+ * 1. no value of an existing codec ID changes (that would break ABI),
+ * 2. it is as close as possible to similar codecs
+ *
+ * After adding new codec IDs, do not forget to add an entry to the codec
+ * descriptor list and bump libavcodec minor version.
+ */
+enum AVCodecID {
+    AV_CODEC_ID_NONE,
+
+    /* video codecs */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG1VIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG2VIDEO, ///< preferred ID for MPEG-1/2 video decoding
+    AV_CODEC_ID_H261,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_H263,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RV10,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RV20,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MJPEG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MJPEGB,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_LJPEG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SP5X,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_JPEGLS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RAWVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSMPEG4V1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSMPEG4V2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSMPEG4V3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMV2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_H263P,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_H263I,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FLV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SVQ1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SVQ3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DVVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HUFFYUV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CYUV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_H264,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_THEORA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ASV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ASV2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FFV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_4XM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VCR1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CLJR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MDEC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ROQ,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INTERPLAY_VIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XAN_WC3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XAN_WC4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RPZA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CINEPAK,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WS_VQA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSRLE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSVIDEO1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_IDCIN,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_8BPS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SMC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FLIC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEMOTION1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VMDVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSZH,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ZLIB,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_QTRLE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TSCC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ULTI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_QDRAW,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VIXL,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_QPEG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PNG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PPM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PBM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PGM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PGMYUV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PAM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FFVHUFF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RV30,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RV40,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VC1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMV3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_LOCO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WNV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AASC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FRAPS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEMOTION2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BMP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CSCD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MMVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ZMBV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AVS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SMACKVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_NUV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_KMVC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FLASHSV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CAVS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_JPEG2000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VMNC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP5,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP6,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP6F,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TARGA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSICINVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TIERTEXSEQVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TIFF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_GIF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DXA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DNXHD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_THP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SGI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_C93,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BETHSOFTVID,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PTX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TXD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP6A,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AMV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VB,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SUNRAST,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INDEO5,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MIMIC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RL2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ESCAPE124,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DIRAC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BFI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CMV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MOTIONPIXELS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TGV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TGQ,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TQI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AURA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AURA2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_V210X,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TMV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_V210,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DPX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MAD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FRWU,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FLASHSV2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CDGRAPHICS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_R210,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ANM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BINKVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_IFF_ILBM,
+#define AV_CODEC_ID_IFF_BYTERUN1 AV_CODEC_ID_IFF_ILBM
+    AV_CODEC_ID_KGV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_YOP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP8,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PICTOR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ANSI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_A64_MULTI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_A64_MULTI5,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_R10K,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MXPEG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_LAGARITH,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PRORES,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_JV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DFA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMV3IMAGE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VC1IMAGE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_UTVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BMV_VIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VBLE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DXTORY,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_V410,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XWD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CDXL,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XBM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ZEROCODEC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSS1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSA1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TSCC2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MTS2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CLLC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSS2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP9,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AIC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ESCAPE130,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_G2M,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WEBP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HNM4_VIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HEVC,
+#define AV_CODEC_ID_H265 AV_CODEC_ID_HEVC
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FIC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ALIAS_PIX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BRENDER_PIX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PAF_VIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_EXR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VP7,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SANM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SGIRLE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MVC1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MVC2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HQX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TDSC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HQ_HQA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HAP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DDS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DXV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SCREENPRESSO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RSCC,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_Y41P = 0x8000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AVRP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_012V,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AVUI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AYUV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TARGA_Y216,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_V308,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_V408,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_YUV4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AVRN,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CPIA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XFACE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SNOW,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SMVJPEG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_APNG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DAALA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CFHD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEMOTION2RT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_M101,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MAGICYUV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SHEERVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_YLC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PSD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PIXLET,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SPEEDHQ,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FMVC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SCPR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CLEARVIDEO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XPM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BITPACKED,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MSCC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SRGC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SVG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_GDV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FITS,
+
+    /* various PCM "codecs" */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FIRST_AUDIO = 0x10000,     ///< A dummy id pointing at the start of audio codecs
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16LE = 0x10000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U16LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U16BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S8,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U8,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_MULAW,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_ALAW,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S32LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S32BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U32LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U32BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U24LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_U24BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24DAUD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_ZORK,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16LE_PLANAR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_DVD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F32BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F32LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F64BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F64LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_BLURAY,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_LXF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_S302M,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S8_PLANAR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S24LE_PLANAR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S32LE_PLANAR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S16BE_PLANAR,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S64LE = 0x10800,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_S64BE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F16LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_F24LE,
+
+    /* various ADPCM codecs */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_QT = 0x11000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_WAV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_DK3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_DK4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_WS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_SMJPEG,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_MS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_4XM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_XA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_ADX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_G726,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_CT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SWF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_YAMAHA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SBPRO_4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SBPRO_3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_SBPRO_2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_THP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_AMV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_R1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_R3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_R2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_EA_SEAD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_EA_EACS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_XAS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_EA_MAXIS_XA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_ISS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_G722,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_APC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_VIMA,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_AFC = 0x11800,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_OKI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_DTK,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_RAD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_G726LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_THP_LE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_PSX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_AICA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_IMA_DAT4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ADPCM_MTAF,
+
+    /* AMR */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AMR_NB = 0x12000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AMR_WB,
+
+    /* RealAudio codecs*/
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RA_144 = 0x13000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RA_288,
+
+    /* various DPCM codecs */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ROQ_DPCM = 0x14000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INTERPLAY_DPCM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XAN_DPCM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SOL_DPCM,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SDX2_DPCM = 0x14800,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_GREMLIN_DPCM,
+
+    /* audio codecs */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MP2 = 0x15000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MP3, ///< preferred ID for decoding MPEG audio layer 1, 2 or 3
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AAC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AC3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DTS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VORBIS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DVAUDIO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMAV1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMAV2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MACE3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MACE6,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VMDAUDIO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FLAC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MP3ADU,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MP3ON4,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SHORTEN,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ALAC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WESTWOOD_SND1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_GSM, ///< as in Berlin toast format
+    AV_CODEC_ID_QDM2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_COOK,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TRUESPEECH,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TTA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SMACKAUDIO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_QCELP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WAVPACK,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSICINAUDIO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_IMC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MUSEPACK7,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MLP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_GSM_MS, /* as found in WAV */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_APE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_NELLYMOSER,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MUSEPACK8,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SPEEX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMAVOICE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMAPRO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WMALOSSLESS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3P,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_EAC3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SIPR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MP1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TWINVQ,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TRUEHD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MP4ALS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BINKAUDIO_RDFT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BINKAUDIO_DCT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_AAC_LATM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_QDMC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CELT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_G723_1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_G729,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_8SVX_EXP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_8SVX_FIB,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BMV_AUDIO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_RALF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_IAC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ILBC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_OPUS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_COMFORT_NOISE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TAK,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_METASOUND,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PAF_AUDIO,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ON2AVC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSS_SP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_CODEC2,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FFWAVESYNTH = 0x15800,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SONIC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SONIC_LS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_EVRC,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SMV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_LSBF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_MSBF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_LSBF_PLANAR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DSD_MSBF_PLANAR,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_4GV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_INTERPLAY_ACM,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XMA1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XMA2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DST,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3AL,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ATRAC3PAL,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DOLBY_E,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_APTX,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_APTX_HD,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SBC,
+
+    /* subtitle codecs */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FIRST_SUBTITLE = 0x17000,          ///< A dummy ID pointing at the start of subtitle codecs.
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DVD_SUBTITLE = 0x17000,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DVB_SUBTITLE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TEXT,  ///< raw UTF-8 text
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XSUB,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SSA,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MOV_TEXT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HDMV_PGS_SUBTITLE,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DVB_TELETEXT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SRT,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MICRODVD   = 0x17800,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_EIA_608,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_JACOSUB,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SAMI,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_REALTEXT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_STL,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SUBVIEWER1,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SUBVIEWER,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SUBRIP,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WEBVTT,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MPL2,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_VPLAYER,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PJS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_ASS,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_HDMV_TEXT_SUBTITLE,
+
+    /* other specific kind of codecs (generally used for attachments) */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FIRST_UNKNOWN = 0x18000,           ///< A dummy ID pointing at the start of various fake codecs.
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TTF = 0x18000,
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SCTE_35, ///< Contain timestamp estimated through PCR of program stream.
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BINTEXT    = 0x18800,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_XBIN,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_IDF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_OTF,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_SMPTE_KLV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_DVD_NAV,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_TIMED_ID3,
+    AV_CODEC_ID_BIN_DATA,
+
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_PROBE = 0x19000, ///< codec_id is not known (like AV_CODEC_ID_NONE) but lavf should attempt to identify it
+
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG2TS = 0x20000, /**< _FAKE_ codec to indicate a raw MPEG-2 TS
+                                * stream (only used by libavformat) */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_MPEG4SYSTEMS = 0x20001, /**< _FAKE_ codec to indicate a MPEG-4 Systems
+                                * stream (only used by libavformat) */
+    AV_CODEC_ID_FFMETADATA = 0x21000,   ///< Dummy codec for streams containing only metadata information.
+    AV_CODEC_ID_WRAPPED_AVFRAME = 0x21001, ///< Passthrough codec, AVFrames wrapped in AVPacket
+};
+
+/**
+ * This struct describes the properties of a single codec described by an
+ * AVCodecID.
+ * @see avcodec_descriptor_get()
+ */
+typedef struct AVCodecDescriptor {
+    enum AVCodecID     id;
+    enum AVMediaType type;
+    /**
+     * Name of the codec described by this descriptor. It is non-empty and
+     * unique for each codec descriptor. It should contain alphanumeric
+     * characters and '_' only.
+     */
+    const char      *name;
+    /**
+     * A more descriptive name for this codec. May be NULL.
+     */
+    const char *long_name;
+    /**
+     * Codec properties, a combination of AV_CODEC_PROP_* flags.
+     */
+    int             props;
+    /**
+     * MIME type(s) associated with the codec.
+     * May be NULL; if not, a NULL-terminated array of MIME types.
+     * The first item is always non-NULL and is the preferred MIME type.
+     */
+    const char *const *mime_types;
+    /**
+     * If non-NULL, an array of profiles recognized for this codec.
+     * Terminated with FF_PROFILE_UNKNOWN.
+     */
+    const struct AVProfile *profiles;
+} AVCodecDescriptor;
+
+/**
+ * Codec uses only intra compression.
+ * Video and audio codecs only.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_PROP_INTRA_ONLY    (1 << 0)
+/**
+ * Codec supports lossy compression. Audio and video codecs only.
+ * @note a codec may support both lossy and lossless
+ * compression modes
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_PROP_LOSSY         (1 << 1)
+/**
+ * Codec supports lossless compression. Audio and video codecs only.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_PROP_LOSSLESS      (1 << 2)
+/**
+ * Codec supports frame reordering. That is, the coded order (the order in which
+ * the encoded packets are output by the encoders / stored / input to the
+ * decoders) may be different from the presentation order of the corresponding
+ * frames.
+ *
+ * For codecs that do not have this property set, PTS and DTS should always be
+ * equal.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_PROP_REORDER       (1 << 3)
+/**
+ * Subtitle codec is bitmap based
+ * Decoded AVSubtitle data can be read from the AVSubtitleRect->pict field.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_PROP_BITMAP_SUB    (1 << 16)
+/**
+ * Subtitle codec is text based.
+ * Decoded AVSubtitle data can be read from the AVSubtitleRect->ass field.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_PROP_TEXT_SUB      (1 << 17)
+
+/**
+ * @ingroup lavc_decoding
+ * Required number of additionally allocated bytes at the end of the input bitstream for decoding.
+ * This is mainly needed because some optimized bitstream readers read
+ * 32 or 64 bit at once and could read over the end.<br>
+ * Note: If the first 23 bits of the additional bytes are not 0, then damaged
+ * MPEG bitstreams could cause overread and segfault.
+ */
+#define AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE 64
+
+/**
+ * @ingroup lavc_encoding
+ * minimum encoding buffer size
+ * Used to avoid some checks during header writing.
+ */
+#define AV_INPUT_BUFFER_MIN_SIZE 16384
+
+/**
+ * @ingroup lavc_decoding
+ */
+enum AVDiscard{
+    /* We leave some space between them for extensions (drop some
+     * keyframes for intra-only or drop just some bidir frames). */
+    AVDISCARD_NONE    =-16, ///< discard nothing
+    AVDISCARD_DEFAULT =  0, ///< discard useless packets like 0 size packets in avi
+    AVDISCARD_NONREF  =  8, ///< discard all non reference
+    AVDISCARD_BIDIR   = 16, ///< discard all bidirectional frames
+    AVDISCARD_NONINTRA= 24, ///< discard all non intra frames
+    AVDISCARD_NONKEY  = 32, ///< discard all frames except keyframes
+    AVDISCARD_ALL     = 48, ///< discard all
+};
+
+enum AVAudioServiceType {
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_MAIN              = 0,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_EFFECTS           = 1,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_VISUALLY_IMPAIRED = 2,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_HEARING_IMPAIRED  = 3,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_DIALOGUE          = 4,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_COMMENTARY        = 5,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_EMERGENCY         = 6,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_VOICE_OVER        = 7,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_KARAOKE           = 8,
+    AV_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE_NB                   , ///< Not part of ABI
+};
+
+/**
+ * @ingroup lavc_encoding
+ */
+typedef struct RcOverride{
+    int start_frame;
+    int end_frame;
+    int qscale; // If this is 0 then quality_factor will be used instead.
+    float quality_factor;
+} RcOverride;
+
+/* encoding support
+   These flags can be passed in AVCodecContext.flags before initialization.
+   Note: Not everything is supported yet.
+*/
+
+/**
+ * Allow decoders to produce frames with data planes that are not aligned
+ * to CPU requirements (e.g. due to cropping).
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_UNALIGNED       (1 <<  0)
+/**
+ * Use fixed qscale.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_QSCALE          (1 <<  1)
+/**
+ * 4 MV per MB allowed / advanced prediction for H.263.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_4MV             (1 <<  2)
+/**
+ * Output even those frames that might be corrupted.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_OUTPUT_CORRUPT  (1 <<  3)
+/**
+ * Use qpel MC.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_QPEL            (1 <<  4)
+/**
+ * Use internal 2pass ratecontrol in first pass mode.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_PASS1           (1 <<  9)
+/**
+ * Use internal 2pass ratecontrol in second pass mode.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_PASS2           (1 << 10)
+/**
+ * loop filter.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_LOOP_FILTER     (1 << 11)
+/**
+ * Only decode/encode grayscale.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_GRAY            (1 << 13)
+/**
+ * error[?] variables will be set during encoding.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_PSNR            (1 << 15)
+/**
+ * Input bitstream might be truncated at a random location
+ * instead of only at frame boundaries.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_TRUNCATED       (1 << 16)
+/**
+ * Use interlaced DCT.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_INTERLACED_DCT  (1 << 18)
+/**
+ * Force low delay.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_LOW_DELAY       (1 << 19)
+/**
+ * Place global headers in extradata instead of every keyframe.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_GLOBAL_HEADER   (1 << 22)
+/**
+ * Use only bitexact stuff (except (I)DCT).
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_BITEXACT        (1 << 23)
+/* Fx : Flag for H.263+ extra options */
+/**
+ * H.263 advanced intra coding / MPEG-4 AC prediction
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_AC_PRED         (1 << 24)
+/**
+ * interlaced motion estimation
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_INTERLACED_ME   (1 << 29)
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG_CLOSED_GOP      (1U << 31)
+
+/**
+ * Allow non spec compliant speedup tricks.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_FAST           (1 <<  0)
+/**
+ * Skip bitstream encoding.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_NO_OUTPUT      (1 <<  2)
+/**
+ * Place global headers at every keyframe instead of in extradata.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_LOCAL_HEADER   (1 <<  3)
+
+/**
+ * timecode is in drop frame format. DEPRECATED!!!!
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_DROP_FRAME_TIMECODE (1 << 13)
+
+/**
+ * Input bitstream might be truncated at a packet boundaries
+ * instead of only at frame boundaries.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_CHUNKS         (1 << 15)
+/**
+ * Discard cropping information from SPS.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_IGNORE_CROP    (1 << 16)
+
+/**
+ * Show all frames before the first keyframe
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_SHOW_ALL       (1 << 22)
+/**
+ * Export motion vectors through frame side data
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_EXPORT_MVS     (1 << 28)
+/**
+ * Do not skip samples and export skip information as frame side data
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_SKIP_MANUAL    (1 << 29)
+/**
+ * Do not reset ASS ReadOrder field on flush (subtitles decoding)
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_FLAG2_RO_FLUSH_NOOP  (1 << 30)
+
+/* Unsupported options :
+ *              Syntax Arithmetic coding (SAC)
+ *              Reference Picture Selection
+ *              Independent Segment Decoding */
+/* /Fx */
+/* codec capabilities */
+
+/**
+ * Decoder can use draw_horiz_band callback.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_DRAW_HORIZ_BAND     (1 <<  0)
+/**
+ * Codec uses get_buffer() for allocating buffers and supports custom allocators.
+ * If not set, it might not use get_buffer() at all or use operations that
+ * assume the buffer was allocated by avcodec_default_get_buffer.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1                 (1 <<  1)
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_TRUNCATED           (1 <<  3)
+/**
+ * Encoder or decoder requires flushing with NULL input at the end in order to
+ * give the complete and correct output.
+ *
+ * NOTE: If this flag is not set, the codec is guaranteed to never be fed with
+ *       with NULL data. The user can still send NULL data to the public encode
+ *       or decode function, but libavcodec will not pass it along to the codec
+ *       unless this flag is set.
+ *
+ * Decoders:
+ * The decoder has a non-zero delay and needs to be fed with avpkt->data=NULL,
+ * avpkt->size=0 at the end to get the delayed data until the decoder no longer
+ * returns frames.
+ *
+ * Encoders:
+ * The encoder needs to be fed with NULL data at the end of encoding until the
+ * encoder no longer returns data.
+ *
+ * NOTE: For encoders implementing the AVCodec.encode2() function, setting this
+ *       flag also means that the encoder must set the pts and duration for
+ *       each output packet. If this flag is not set, the pts and duration will
+ *       be determined by libavcodec from the input frame.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY               (1 <<  5)
+/**
+ * Codec can be fed a final frame with a smaller size.
+ * This can be used to prevent truncation of the last audio samples.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_SMALL_LAST_FRAME    (1 <<  6)
+
+/**
+ * Codec can output multiple frames per AVPacket
+ * Normally demuxers return one frame at a time, demuxers which do not do
+ * are connected to a parser to split what they return into proper frames.
+ * This flag is reserved to the very rare category of codecs which have a
+ * bitstream that cannot be split into frames without timeconsuming
+ * operations like full decoding. Demuxers carrying such bitstreams thus
+ * may return multiple frames in a packet. This has many disadvantages like
+ * prohibiting stream copy in many cases thus it should only be considered
+ * as a last resort.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_SUBFRAMES           (1 <<  8)
+/**
+ * Codec is experimental and is thus avoided in favor of non experimental
+ * encoders
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_EXPERIMENTAL        (1 <<  9)
+/**
+ * Codec should fill in channel configuration and samplerate instead of container
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_CHANNEL_CONF        (1 << 10)
+/**
+ * Codec supports frame-level multithreading.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_FRAME_THREADS       (1 << 12)
+/**
+ * Codec supports slice-based (or partition-based) multithreading.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_SLICE_THREADS       (1 << 13)
+/**
+ * Codec supports changed parameters at any point.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_PARAM_CHANGE        (1 << 14)
+/**
+ * Codec supports avctx->thread_count == 0 (auto).
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_AUTO_THREADS        (1 << 15)
+/**
+ * Audio encoder supports receiving a different number of samples in each call.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_VARIABLE_FRAME_SIZE (1 << 16)
+/**
+ * Decoder is not a preferred choice for probing.
+ * This indicates that the decoder is not a good choice for probing.
+ * It could for example be an expensive to spin up hardware decoder,
+ * or it could simply not provide a lot of useful information about
+ * the stream.
+ * A decoder marked with this flag should only be used as last resort
+ * choice for probing.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_AVOID_PROBING       (1 << 17)
+/**
+ * Codec is intra only.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_INTRA_ONLY       0x40000000
+/**
+ * Codec is lossless.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_LOSSLESS         0x80000000
+
+/**
+ * Codec is backed by a hardware implementation. Typically used to
+ * identify a non-hwaccel hardware decoder. For information about hwaccels, use
+ * avcodec_get_hw_config() instead.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_HARDWARE            (1 << 18)
+
+/**
+ * Codec is potentially backed by a hardware implementation, but not
+ * necessarily. This is used instead of AV_CODEC_CAP_HARDWARE, if the
+ * implementation provides some sort of internal fallback.
+ */
+#define AV_CODEC_CAP_HYBRID              (1 << 19)
+
+/**
+ * Pan Scan area.
+ * This specifies the area which should be displayed.
+ * Note there may be multiple such areas for one frame.
+ */
+typedef struct AVPanScan {
+    /**
+     * id
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int id;
+
+    /**
+     * width and height in 1/16 pel
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int width;
+    int height;
+
+    /**
+     * position of the top left corner in 1/16 pel for up to 3 fields/frames
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int16_t position[3][2];
+} AVPanScan;
+
+/**
+ * This structure describes the bitrate properties of an encoded bitstream. It
+ * roughly corresponds to a subset the VBV parameters for MPEG-2 or HRD
+ * parameters for H.264/HEVC.
+ */
+typedef struct AVCPBProperties {
+    /**
+     * Maximum bitrate of the stream, in bits per second.
+     * Zero if unknown or unspecified.
+     */
+    int max_bitrate;
+    /**
+     * Minimum bitrate of the stream, in bits per second.
+     * Zero if unknown or unspecified.
+     */
+    int min_bitrate;
+    /**
+     * Average bitrate of the stream, in bits per second.
+     * Zero if unknown or unspecified.
+     */
+    int avg_bitrate;
+
+    /**
+     * The size of the buffer to which the ratecontrol is applied, in bits.
+     * Zero if unknown or unspecified.
+     */
+    int buffer_size;
+
+    /**
+     * The delay between the time the packet this structure is associated with
+     * is received and the time when it should be decoded, in periods of a 27MHz
+     * clock.
+     *
+     * UINT64_MAX when unknown or unspecified.
+     */
+    uint64_t vbv_delay;
+} AVCPBProperties;
+
+/**
+ * The decoder will keep a reference to the frame and may reuse it later.
+ */
+#define AV_GET_BUFFER_FLAG_REF (1 << 0)
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_packet AVPacket
+ *
+ * Types and functions for working with AVPacket.
+ * @{
+ */
+enum AVPacketSideDataType {
+    /**
+     * An AV_PKT_DATA_PALETTE side data packet contains exactly AVPALETTE_SIZE
+     * bytes worth of palette. This side data signals that a new palette is
+     * present.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_PALETTE,
+
+    /**
+     * The AV_PKT_DATA_NEW_EXTRADATA is used to notify the codec or the format
+     * that the extradata buffer was changed and the receiving side should
+     * act upon it appropriately. The new extradata is embedded in the side
+     * data buffer and should be immediately used for processing the current
+     * frame or packet.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_NEW_EXTRADATA,
+
+    /**
+     * An AV_PKT_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE side data packet is laid out as follows:
+     * @code
+     * u32le param_flags
+     * if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_CHANNEL_COUNT)
+     *     s32le channel_count
+     * if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_CHANNEL_LAYOUT)
+     *     u64le channel_layout
+     * if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_SAMPLE_RATE)
+     *     s32le sample_rate
+     * if (param_flags & AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_DIMENSIONS)
+     *     s32le width
+     *     s32le height
+     * @endcode
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE,
+
+    /**
+     * An AV_PKT_DATA_H263_MB_INFO side data packet contains a number of
+     * structures with info about macroblocks relevant to splitting the
+     * packet into smaller packets on macroblock edges (e.g. as for RFC 2190).
+     * That is, it does not necessarily contain info about all macroblocks,
+     * as long as the distance between macroblocks in the info is smaller
+     * than the target payload size.
+     * Each MB info structure is 12 bytes, and is laid out as follows:
+     * @code
+     * u32le bit offset from the start of the packet
+     * u8    current quantizer at the start of the macroblock
+     * u8    GOB number
+     * u16le macroblock address within the GOB
+     * u8    horizontal MV predictor
+     * u8    vertical MV predictor
+     * u8    horizontal MV predictor for block number 3
+     * u8    vertical MV predictor for block number 3
+     * @endcode
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_H263_MB_INFO,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data should be associated with an audio stream and contains
+     * ReplayGain information in form of the AVReplayGain struct.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_REPLAYGAIN,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data contains a 3x3 transformation matrix describing an affine
+     * transformation that needs to be applied to the decoded video frames for
+     * correct presentation.
+     *
+     * See libavutil/display.h for a detailed description of the data.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_DISPLAYMATRIX,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data should be associated with a video stream and contains
+     * Stereoscopic 3D information in form of the AVStereo3D struct.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_STEREO3D,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data should be associated with an audio stream and corresponds
+     * to enum AVAudioServiceType.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_AUDIO_SERVICE_TYPE,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data contains quality related information from the encoder.
+     * @code
+     * u32le quality factor of the compressed frame. Allowed range is between 1 (good) and FF_LAMBDA_MAX (bad).
+     * u8    picture type
+     * u8    error count
+     * u16   reserved
+     * u64le[error count] sum of squared differences between encoder in and output
+     * @endcode
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_QUALITY_STATS,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data contains an integer value representing the stream index
+     * of a "fallback" track.  A fallback track indicates an alternate
+     * track to use when the current track can not be decoded for some reason.
+     * e.g. no decoder available for codec.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_FALLBACK_TRACK,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data corresponds to the AVCPBProperties struct.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_CPB_PROPERTIES,
+
+    /**
+     * Recommmends skipping the specified number of samples
+     * @code
+     * u32le number of samples to skip from start of this packet
+     * u32le number of samples to skip from end of this packet
+     * u8    reason for start skip
+     * u8    reason for end   skip (0=padding silence, 1=convergence)
+     * @endcode
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_SKIP_SAMPLES,
+
+    /**
+     * An AV_PKT_DATA_JP_DUALMONO side data packet indicates that
+     * the packet may contain "dual mono" audio specific to Japanese DTV
+     * and if it is true, recommends only the selected channel to be used.
+     * @code
+     * u8    selected channels (0=mail/left, 1=sub/right, 2=both)
+     * @endcode
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_JP_DUALMONO,
+
+    /**
+     * A list of zero terminated key/value strings. There is no end marker for
+     * the list, so it is required to rely on the side data size to stop.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_STRINGS_METADATA,
+
+    /**
+     * Subtitle event position
+     * @code
+     * u32le x1
+     * u32le y1
+     * u32le x2
+     * u32le y2
+     * @endcode
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_SUBTITLE_POSITION,
+
+    /**
+     * Data found in BlockAdditional element of matroska container. There is
+     * no end marker for the data, so it is required to rely on the side data
+     * size to recognize the end. 8 byte id (as found in BlockAddId) followed
+     * by data.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_MATROSKA_BLOCKADDITIONAL,
+
+    /**
+     * The optional first identifier line of a WebVTT cue.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_WEBVTT_IDENTIFIER,
+
+    /**
+     * The optional settings (rendering instructions) that immediately
+     * follow the timestamp specifier of a WebVTT cue.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_WEBVTT_SETTINGS,
+
+    /**
+     * A list of zero terminated key/value strings. There is no end marker for
+     * the list, so it is required to rely on the side data size to stop. This
+     * side data includes updated metadata which appeared in the stream.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_METADATA_UPDATE,
+
+    /**
+     * MPEGTS stream ID, this is required to pass the stream ID
+     * information from the demuxer to the corresponding muxer.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_MPEGTS_STREAM_ID,
+
+    /**
+     * Mastering display metadata (based on SMPTE-2086:2014). This metadata
+     * should be associated with a video stream and contains data in the form
+     * of the AVMasteringDisplayMetadata struct.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_MASTERING_DISPLAY_METADATA,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data should be associated with a video stream and corresponds
+     * to the AVSphericalMapping structure.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_SPHERICAL,
+
+    /**
+     * Content light level (based on CTA-861.3). This metadata should be
+     * associated with a video stream and contains data in the form of the
+     * AVContentLightMetadata struct.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_CONTENT_LIGHT_LEVEL,
+
+    /**
+     * ATSC A53 Part 4 Closed Captions. This metadata should be associated with
+     * a video stream. A53 CC bitstream is stored as uint8_t in AVPacketSideData.data.
+     * The number of bytes of CC data is AVPacketSideData.size.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_A53_CC,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data is encryption initialization data.
+     * The format is not part of ABI, use av_encryption_init_info_* methods to
+     * access.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_ENCRYPTION_INIT_INFO,
+
+    /**
+     * This side data contains encryption info for how to decrypt the packet.
+     * The format is not part of ABI, use av_encryption_info_* methods to access.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_ENCRYPTION_INFO,
+
+    /**
+     * The number of side data types.
+     * This is not part of the public API/ABI in the sense that it may
+     * change when new side data types are added.
+     * This must stay the last enum value.
+     * If its value becomes huge, some code using it
+     * needs to be updated as it assumes it to be smaller than other limits.
+     */
+    AV_PKT_DATA_NB
+};
+
+#define AV_PKT_DATA_QUALITY_FACTOR AV_PKT_DATA_QUALITY_STATS //DEPRECATED
+
+typedef struct AVPacketSideData {
+    uint8_t *data;
+    int      size;
+    enum AVPacketSideDataType type;
+} AVPacketSideData;
+
+/**
+ * This structure stores compressed data. It is typically exported by demuxers
+ * and then passed as input to decoders, or received as output from encoders and
+ * then passed to muxers.
+ *
+ * For video, it should typically contain one compressed frame. For audio it may
+ * contain several compressed frames. Encoders are allowed to output empty
+ * packets, with no compressed data, containing only side data
+ * (e.g. to update some stream parameters at the end of encoding).
+ *
+ * AVPacket is one of the few structs in FFmpeg, whose size is a part of public
+ * ABI. Thus it may be allocated on stack and no new fields can be added to it
+ * without libavcodec and libavformat major bump.
+ *
+ * The semantics of data ownership depends on the buf field.
+ * If it is set, the packet data is dynamically allocated and is
+ * valid indefinitely until a call to av_packet_unref() reduces the
+ * reference count to 0.
+ *
+ * If the buf field is not set av_packet_ref() would make a copy instead
+ * of increasing the reference count.
+ *
+ * The side data is always allocated with av_malloc(), copied by
+ * av_packet_ref() and freed by av_packet_unref().
+ *
+ * @see av_packet_ref
+ * @see av_packet_unref
+ */
+typedef struct AVPacket {
+    /**
+     * A reference to the reference-counted buffer where the packet data is
+     * stored.
+     * May be NULL, then the packet data is not reference-counted.
+     */
+    AVBufferRef *buf;
+    /**
+     * Presentation timestamp in AVStream->time_base units; the time at which
+     * the decompressed packet will be presented to the user.
+     * Can be AV_NOPTS_VALUE if it is not stored in the file.
+     * pts MUST be larger or equal to dts as presentation cannot happen before
+     * decompression, unless one wants to view hex dumps. Some formats misuse
+     * the terms dts and pts/cts to mean something different. Such timestamps
+     * must be converted to true pts/dts before they are stored in AVPacket.
+     */
+    int64_t pts;
+    /**
+     * Decompression timestamp in AVStream->time_base units; the time at which
+     * the packet is decompressed.
+     * Can be AV_NOPTS_VALUE if it is not stored in the file.
+     */
+    int64_t dts;
+    uint8_t *data;
+    int   size;
+    int   stream_index;
+    /**
+     * A combination of AV_PKT_FLAG values
+     */
+    int   flags;
+    /**
+     * Additional packet data that can be provided by the container.
+     * Packet can contain several types of side information.
+     */
+    AVPacketSideData *side_data;
+    int side_data_elems;
+
+    /**
+     * Duration of this packet in AVStream->time_base units, 0 if unknown.
+     * Equals next_pts - this_pts in presentation order.
+     */
+    int64_t duration;
+
+    int64_t pos;                            ///< byte position in stream, -1 if unknown
+
+#if FF_API_CONVERGENCE_DURATION
+    /**
+     * @deprecated Same as the duration field, but as int64_t. This was required
+     * for Matroska subtitles, whose duration values could overflow when the
+     * duration field was still an int.
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int64_t convergence_duration;
+#endif
+} AVPacket;
+#define AV_PKT_FLAG_KEY     0x0001 ///< The packet contains a keyframe
+#define AV_PKT_FLAG_CORRUPT 0x0002 ///< The packet content is corrupted
+/**
+ * Flag is used to discard packets which are required to maintain valid
+ * decoder state but are not required for output and should be dropped
+ * after decoding.
+ **/
+#define AV_PKT_FLAG_DISCARD   0x0004
+/**
+ * The packet comes from a trusted source.
+ *
+ * Otherwise-unsafe constructs such as arbitrary pointers to data
+ * outside the packet may be followed.
+ */
+#define AV_PKT_FLAG_TRUSTED   0x0008
+/**
+ * Flag is used to indicate packets that contain frames that can
+ * be discarded by the decoder.  I.e. Non-reference frames.
+ */
+#define AV_PKT_FLAG_DISPOSABLE 0x0010
+
+
+enum AVSideDataParamChangeFlags {
+    AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_CHANNEL_COUNT  = 0x0001,
+    AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_CHANNEL_LAYOUT = 0x0002,
+    AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_SAMPLE_RATE    = 0x0004,
+    AV_SIDE_DATA_PARAM_CHANGE_DIMENSIONS     = 0x0008,
+};
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+struct AVCodecInternal;
+
+enum AVFieldOrder {
+    AV_FIELD_UNKNOWN,
+    AV_FIELD_PROGRESSIVE,
+    AV_FIELD_TT,          //< Top coded_first, top displayed first
+    AV_FIELD_BB,          //< Bottom coded first, bottom displayed first
+    AV_FIELD_TB,          //< Top coded first, bottom displayed first
+    AV_FIELD_BT,          //< Bottom coded first, top displayed first
+};
+
+/**
+ * main external API structure.
+ * New fields can be added to the end with minor version bumps.
+ * Removal, reordering and changes to existing fields require a major
+ * version bump.
+ * You can use AVOptions (av_opt* / av_set/get*()) to access these fields from user
+ * applications.
+ * The name string for AVOptions options matches the associated command line
+ * parameter name and can be found in libavcodec/options_table.h
+ * The AVOption/command line parameter names differ in some cases from the C
+ * structure field names for historic reasons or brevity.
+ * sizeof(AVCodecContext) must not be used outside libav*.
+ */
+typedef struct AVCodecContext {
+    /**
+     * information on struct for av_log
+     * - set by avcodec_alloc_context3
+     */
+    const AVClass *av_class;
+    int log_level_offset;
+
+    enum AVMediaType codec_type; /* see AVMEDIA_TYPE_xxx */
+    const struct AVCodec  *codec;
+    enum AVCodecID     codec_id; /* see AV_CODEC_ID_xxx */
+
+    /**
+     * fourcc (LSB first, so "ABCD" -> ('D'<<24) + ('C'<<16) + ('B'<<8) + 'A').
+     * This is used to work around some encoder bugs.
+     * A demuxer should set this to what is stored in the field used to identify the codec.
+     * If there are multiple such fields in a container then the demuxer should choose the one
+     * which maximizes the information about the used codec.
+     * If the codec tag field in a container is larger than 32 bits then the demuxer should
+     * remap the longer ID to 32 bits with a table or other structure. Alternatively a new
+     * extra_codec_tag + size could be added but for this a clear advantage must be demonstrated
+     * first.
+     * - encoding: Set by user, if not then the default based on codec_id will be used.
+     * - decoding: Set by user, will be converted to uppercase by libavcodec during init.
+     */
+    unsigned int codec_tag;
+
+    void *priv_data;
+
+    /**
+     * Private context used for internal data.
+     *
+     * Unlike priv_data, this is not codec-specific. It is used in general
+     * libavcodec functions.
+     */
+    struct AVCodecInternal *internal;
+
+    /**
+     * Private data of the user, can be used to carry app specific stuff.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    void *opaque;
+
+    /**
+     * the average bitrate
+     * - encoding: Set by user; unused for constant quantizer encoding.
+     * - decoding: Set by user, may be overwritten by libavcodec
+     *             if this info is available in the stream
+     */
+    int64_t bit_rate;
+
+    /**
+     * number of bits the bitstream is allowed to diverge from the reference.
+     *           the reference can be CBR (for CBR pass1) or VBR (for pass2)
+     * - encoding: Set by user; unused for constant quantizer encoding.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int bit_rate_tolerance;
+
+    /**
+     * Global quality for codecs which cannot change it per frame.
+     * This should be proportional to MPEG-1/2/4 qscale.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int global_quality;
+
+    /**
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int compression_level;
+#define FF_COMPRESSION_DEFAULT -1
+
+    /**
+     * AV_CODEC_FLAG_*.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int flags;
+
+    /**
+     * AV_CODEC_FLAG2_*
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int flags2;
+
+    /**
+     * some codecs need / can use extradata like Huffman tables.
+     * MJPEG: Huffman tables
+     * rv10: additional flags
+     * MPEG-4: global headers (they can be in the bitstream or here)
+     * The allocated memory should be AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE bytes larger
+     * than extradata_size to avoid problems if it is read with the bitstream reader.
+     * The bytewise contents of extradata must not depend on the architecture or CPU endianness.
+     * - encoding: Set/allocated/freed by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set/allocated/freed by user.
+     */
+    uint8_t *extradata;
+    int extradata_size;
+
+    /**
+     * This is the fundamental unit of time (in seconds) in terms
+     * of which frame timestamps are represented. For fixed-fps content,
+     * timebase should be 1/framerate and timestamp increments should be
+     * identically 1.
+     * This often, but not always is the inverse of the frame rate or field rate
+     * for video. 1/time_base is not the average frame rate if the frame rate is not
+     * constant.
+     *
+     * Like containers, elementary streams also can store timestamps, 1/time_base
+     * is the unit in which these timestamps are specified.
+     * As example of such codec time base see ISO/IEC 14496-2:2001(E)
+     * vop_time_increment_resolution and fixed_vop_rate
+     * (fixed_vop_rate == 0 implies that it is different from the framerate)
+     *
+     * - encoding: MUST be set by user.
+     * - decoding: the use of this field for decoding is deprecated.
+     *             Use framerate instead.
+     */
+    AVRational time_base;
+
+    /**
+     * For some codecs, the time base is closer to the field rate than the frame rate.
+     * Most notably, H.264 and MPEG-2 specify time_base as half of frame duration
+     * if no telecine is used ...
+     *
+     * Set to time_base ticks per frame. Default 1, e.g., H.264/MPEG-2 set it to 2.
+     */
+    int ticks_per_frame;
+
+    /**
+     * Codec delay.
+     *
+     * Encoding: Number of frames delay there will be from the encoder input to
+     *           the decoder output. (we assume the decoder matches the spec)
+     * Decoding: Number of frames delay in addition to what a standard decoder
+     *           as specified in the spec would produce.
+     *
+     * Video:
+     *   Number of frames the decoded output will be delayed relative to the
+     *   encoded input.
+     *
+     * Audio:
+     *   For encoding, this field is unused (see initial_padding).
+     *
+     *   For decoding, this is the number of samples the decoder needs to
+     *   output before the decoder's output is valid. When seeking, you should
+     *   start decoding this many samples prior to your desired seek point.
+     *
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int delay;
+
+
+    /* video only */
+    /**
+     * picture width / height.
+     *
+     * @note Those fields may not match the values of the last
+     * AVFrame output by avcodec_decode_video2 due frame
+     * reordering.
+     *
+     * - encoding: MUST be set by user.
+     * - decoding: May be set by the user before opening the decoder if known e.g.
+     *             from the container. Some decoders will require the dimensions
+     *             to be set by the caller. During decoding, the decoder may
+     *             overwrite those values as required while parsing the data.
+     */
+    int width, height;
+
+    /**
+     * Bitstream width / height, may be different from width/height e.g. when
+     * the decoded frame is cropped before being output or lowres is enabled.
+     *
+     * @note Those field may not match the value of the last
+     * AVFrame output by avcodec_receive_frame() due frame
+     * reordering.
+     *
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: May be set by the user before opening the decoder if known
+     *             e.g. from the container. During decoding, the decoder may
+     *             overwrite those values as required while parsing the data.
+     */
+    int coded_width, coded_height;
+
+    /**
+     * the number of pictures in a group of pictures, or 0 for intra_only
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int gop_size;
+
+    /**
+     * Pixel format, see AV_PIX_FMT_xxx.
+     * May be set by the demuxer if known from headers.
+     * May be overridden by the decoder if it knows better.
+     *
+     * @note This field may not match the value of the last
+     * AVFrame output by avcodec_receive_frame() due frame
+     * reordering.
+     *
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user if known, overridden by libavcodec while
+     *             parsing the data.
+     */
+    enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt;
+
+    /**
+     * If non NULL, 'draw_horiz_band' is called by the libavcodec
+     * decoder to draw a horizontal band. It improves cache usage. Not
+     * all codecs can do that. You must check the codec capabilities
+     * beforehand.
+     * When multithreading is used, it may be called from multiple threads
+     * at the same time; threads might draw different parts of the same AVFrame,
+     * or multiple AVFrames, and there is no guarantee that slices will be drawn
+     * in order.
+     * The function is also used by hardware acceleration APIs.
+     * It is called at least once during frame decoding to pass
+     * the data needed for hardware render.
+     * In that mode instead of pixel data, AVFrame points to
+     * a structure specific to the acceleration API. The application
+     * reads the structure and can change some fields to indicate progress
+     * or mark state.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     * @param height the height of the slice
+     * @param y the y position of the slice
+     * @param type 1->top field, 2->bottom field, 3->frame
+     * @param offset offset into the AVFrame.data from which the slice should be read
+     */
+    void (*draw_horiz_band)(struct AVCodecContext *s,
+                            const AVFrame *src, int offset[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS],
+                            int y, int type, int height);
+
+    /**
+     * callback to negotiate the pixelFormat
+     * @param fmt is the list of formats which are supported by the codec,
+     * it is terminated by -1 as 0 is a valid format, the formats are ordered by quality.
+     * The first is always the native one.
+     * @note The callback may be called again immediately if initialization for
+     * the selected (hardware-accelerated) pixel format failed.
+     * @warning Behavior is undefined if the callback returns a value not
+     * in the fmt list of formats.
+     * @return the chosen format
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user, if not set the native format will be chosen.
+     */
+    enum AVPixelFormat (*get_format)(struct AVCodecContext *s, const enum AVPixelFormat * fmt);
+
+    /**
+     * maximum number of B-frames between non-B-frames
+     * Note: The output will be delayed by max_b_frames+1 relative to the input.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int max_b_frames;
+
+    /**
+     * qscale factor between IP and B-frames
+     * If > 0 then the last P-frame quantizer will be used (q= lastp_q*factor+offset).
+     * If < 0 then normal ratecontrol will be done (q= -normal_q*factor+offset).
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float b_quant_factor;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int b_frame_strategy;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * qscale offset between IP and B-frames
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float b_quant_offset;
+
+    /**
+     * Size of the frame reordering buffer in the decoder.
+     * For MPEG-2 it is 1 IPB or 0 low delay IP.
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int has_b_frames;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int mpeg_quant;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * qscale factor between P- and I-frames
+     * If > 0 then the last P-frame quantizer will be used (q = lastp_q * factor + offset).
+     * If < 0 then normal ratecontrol will be done (q= -normal_q*factor+offset).
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float i_quant_factor;
+
+    /**
+     * qscale offset between P and I-frames
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float i_quant_offset;
+
+    /**
+     * luminance masking (0-> disabled)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float lumi_masking;
+
+    /**
+     * temporary complexity masking (0-> disabled)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float temporal_cplx_masking;
+
+    /**
+     * spatial complexity masking (0-> disabled)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float spatial_cplx_masking;
+
+    /**
+     * p block masking (0-> disabled)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float p_masking;
+
+    /**
+     * darkness masking (0-> disabled)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    float dark_masking;
+
+    /**
+     * slice count
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set by user (or 0).
+     */
+    int slice_count;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+     int prediction_method;
+#define FF_PRED_LEFT   0
+#define FF_PRED_PLANE  1
+#define FF_PRED_MEDIAN 2
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * slice offsets in the frame in bytes
+     * - encoding: Set/allocated by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set/allocated by user (or NULL).
+     */
+    int *slice_offset;
+
+    /**
+     * sample aspect ratio (0 if unknown)
+     * That is the width of a pixel divided by the height of the pixel.
+     * Numerator and denominator must be relatively prime and smaller than 256 for some video standards.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    AVRational sample_aspect_ratio;
+
+    /**
+     * motion estimation comparison function
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int me_cmp;
+    /**
+     * subpixel motion estimation comparison function
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int me_sub_cmp;
+    /**
+     * macroblock comparison function (not supported yet)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int mb_cmp;
+    /**
+     * interlaced DCT comparison function
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int ildct_cmp;
+#define FF_CMP_SAD          0
+#define FF_CMP_SSE          1
+#define FF_CMP_SATD         2
+#define FF_CMP_DCT          3
+#define FF_CMP_PSNR         4
+#define FF_CMP_BIT          5
+#define FF_CMP_RD           6
+#define FF_CMP_ZERO         7
+#define FF_CMP_VSAD         8
+#define FF_CMP_VSSE         9
+#define FF_CMP_NSSE         10
+#define FF_CMP_W53          11
+#define FF_CMP_W97          12
+#define FF_CMP_DCTMAX       13
+#define FF_CMP_DCT264       14
+#define FF_CMP_MEDIAN_SAD   15
+#define FF_CMP_CHROMA       256
+
+    /**
+     * ME diamond size & shape
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int dia_size;
+
+    /**
+     * amount of previous MV predictors (2a+1 x 2a+1 square)
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int last_predictor_count;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int pre_me;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * motion estimation prepass comparison function
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int me_pre_cmp;
+
+    /**
+     * ME prepass diamond size & shape
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int pre_dia_size;
+
+    /**
+     * subpel ME quality
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int me_subpel_quality;
+
+    /**
+     * maximum motion estimation search range in subpel units
+     * If 0 then no limit.
+     *
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int me_range;
+
+    /**
+     * slice flags
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int slice_flags;
+#define SLICE_FLAG_CODED_ORDER    0x0001 ///< draw_horiz_band() is called in coded order instead of display
+#define SLICE_FLAG_ALLOW_FIELD    0x0002 ///< allow draw_horiz_band() with field slices (MPEG-2 field pics)
+#define SLICE_FLAG_ALLOW_PLANE    0x0004 ///< allow draw_horiz_band() with 1 component at a time (SVQ1)
+
+    /**
+     * macroblock decision mode
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int mb_decision;
+#define FF_MB_DECISION_SIMPLE 0        ///< uses mb_cmp
+#define FF_MB_DECISION_BITS   1        ///< chooses the one which needs the fewest bits
+#define FF_MB_DECISION_RD     2        ///< rate distortion
+
+    /**
+     * custom intra quantization matrix
+     * - encoding: Set by user, can be NULL.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    uint16_t *intra_matrix;
+
+    /**
+     * custom inter quantization matrix
+     * - encoding: Set by user, can be NULL.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    uint16_t *inter_matrix;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int scenechange_threshold;
+
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int noise_reduction;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * precision of the intra DC coefficient - 8
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    int intra_dc_precision;
+
+    /**
+     * Number of macroblock rows at the top which are skipped.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int skip_top;
+
+    /**
+     * Number of macroblock rows at the bottom which are skipped.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int skip_bottom;
+
+    /**
+     * minimum MB Lagrange multiplier
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int mb_lmin;
+
+    /**
+     * maximum MB Lagrange multiplier
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int mb_lmax;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /**
+     * @deprecated use encoder private options instead
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int me_penalty_compensation;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int bidir_refine;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int brd_scale;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * minimum GOP size
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int keyint_min;
+
+    /**
+     * number of reference frames
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by lavc.
+     */
+    int refs;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int chromaoffset;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * Note: Value depends upon the compare function used for fullpel ME.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int mv0_threshold;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int b_sensitivity;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * Chromaticity coordinates of the source primaries.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    enum AVColorPrimaries color_primaries;
+
+    /**
+     * Color Transfer Characteristic.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic color_trc;
+
+    /**
+     * YUV colorspace type.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    enum AVColorSpace colorspace;
+
+    /**
+     * MPEG vs JPEG YUV range.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    enum AVColorRange color_range;
+
+    /**
+     * This defines the location of chroma samples.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    enum AVChromaLocation chroma_sample_location;
+
+    /**
+     * Number of slices.
+     * Indicates number of picture subdivisions. Used for parallelized
+     * decoding.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int slices;
+
+    /** Field order
+     * - encoding: set by libavcodec
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    enum AVFieldOrder field_order;
+
+    /* audio only */
+    int sample_rate; ///< samples per second
+    int channels;    ///< number of audio channels
+
+    /**
+     * audio sample format
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    enum AVSampleFormat sample_fmt;  ///< sample format
+
+    /* The following data should not be initialized. */
+    /**
+     * Number of samples per channel in an audio frame.
+     *
+     * - encoding: set by libavcodec in avcodec_open2(). Each submitted frame
+     *   except the last must contain exactly frame_size samples per channel.
+     *   May be 0 when the codec has AV_CODEC_CAP_VARIABLE_FRAME_SIZE set, then the
+     *   frame size is not restricted.
+     * - decoding: may be set by some decoders to indicate constant frame size
+     */
+    int frame_size;
+
+    /**
+     * Frame counter, set by libavcodec.
+     *
+     * - decoding: total number of frames returned from the decoder so far.
+     * - encoding: total number of frames passed to the encoder so far.
+     *
+     *   @note the counter is not incremented if encoding/decoding resulted in
+     *   an error.
+     */
+    int frame_number;
+
+    /**
+     * number of bytes per packet if constant and known or 0
+     * Used by some WAV based audio codecs.
+     */
+    int block_align;
+
+    /**
+     * Audio cutoff bandwidth (0 means "automatic")
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int cutoff;
+
+    /**
+     * Audio channel layout.
+     * - encoding: set by user.
+     * - decoding: set by user, may be overwritten by libavcodec.
+     */
+    uint64_t channel_layout;
+
+    /**
+     * Request decoder to use this channel layout if it can (0 for default)
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    uint64_t request_channel_layout;
+
+    /**
+     * Type of service that the audio stream conveys.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    enum AVAudioServiceType audio_service_type;
+
+    /**
+     * desired sample format
+     * - encoding: Not used.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     * Decoder will decode to this format if it can.
+     */
+    enum AVSampleFormat request_sample_fmt;
+
+    /**
+     * This callback is called at the beginning of each frame to get data
+     * buffer(s) for it. There may be one contiguous buffer for all the data or
+     * there may be a buffer per each data plane or anything in between. What
+     * this means is, you may set however many entries in buf[] you feel necessary.
+     * Each buffer must be reference-counted using the AVBuffer API (see description
+     * of buf[] below).
+     *
+     * The following fields will be set in the frame before this callback is
+     * called:
+     * - format
+     * - width, height (video only)
+     * - sample_rate, channel_layout, nb_samples (audio only)
+     * Their values may differ from the corresponding values in
+     * AVCodecContext. This callback must use the frame values, not the codec
+     * context values, to calculate the required buffer size.
+     *
+     * This callback must fill the following fields in the frame:
+     * - data[]
+     * - linesize[]
+     * - extended_data:
+     *   * if the data is planar audio with more than 8 channels, then this
+     *     callback must allocate and fill extended_data to contain all pointers
+     *     to all data planes. data[] must hold as many pointers as it can.
+     *     extended_data must be allocated with av_malloc() and will be freed in
+     *     av_frame_unref().
+     *   * otherwise extended_data must point to data
+     * - buf[] must contain one or more pointers to AVBufferRef structures. Each of
+     *   the frame's data and extended_data pointers must be contained in these. That
+     *   is, one AVBufferRef for each allocated chunk of memory, not necessarily one
+     *   AVBufferRef per data[] entry. See: av_buffer_create(), av_buffer_alloc(),
+     *   and av_buffer_ref().
+     * - extended_buf and nb_extended_buf must be allocated with av_malloc() by
+     *   this callback and filled with the extra buffers if there are more
+     *   buffers than buf[] can hold. extended_buf will be freed in
+     *   av_frame_unref().
+     *
+     * If AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1 is not set then get_buffer2() must call
+     * avcodec_default_get_buffer2() instead of providing buffers allocated by
+     * some other means.
+     *
+     * Each data plane must be aligned to the maximum required by the target
+     * CPU.
+     *
+     * @see avcodec_default_get_buffer2()
+     *
+     * Video:
+     *
+     * If AV_GET_BUFFER_FLAG_REF is set in flags then the frame may be reused
+     * (read and/or written to if it is writable) later by libavcodec.
+     *
+     * avcodec_align_dimensions2() should be used to find the required width and
+     * height, as they normally need to be rounded up to the next multiple of 16.
+     *
+     * Some decoders do not support linesizes changing between frames.
+     *
+     * If frame multithreading is used and thread_safe_callbacks is set,
+     * this callback may be called from a different thread, but not from more
+     * than one at once. Does not need to be reentrant.
+     *
+     * @see avcodec_align_dimensions2()
+     *
+     * Audio:
+     *
+     * Decoders request a buffer of a particular size by setting
+     * AVFrame.nb_samples prior to calling get_buffer2(). The decoder may,
+     * however, utilize only part of the buffer by setting AVFrame.nb_samples
+     * to a smaller value in the output frame.
+     *
+     * As a convenience, av_samples_get_buffer_size() and
+     * av_samples_fill_arrays() in libavutil may be used by custom get_buffer2()
+     * functions to find the required data size and to fill data pointers and
+     * linesize. In AVFrame.linesize, only linesize[0] may be set for audio
+     * since all planes must be the same size.
+     *
+     * @see av_samples_get_buffer_size(), av_samples_fill_arrays()
+     *
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec, user can override.
+     */
+    int (*get_buffer2)(struct AVCodecContext *s, AVFrame *frame, int flags);
+
+    /**
+     * If non-zero, the decoded audio and video frames returned from
+     * avcodec_decode_video2() and avcodec_decode_audio4() are reference-counted
+     * and are valid indefinitely. The caller must free them with
+     * av_frame_unref() when they are not needed anymore.
+     * Otherwise, the decoded frames must not be freed by the caller and are
+     * only valid until the next decode call.
+     *
+     * This is always automatically enabled if avcodec_receive_frame() is used.
+     *
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: set by the caller before avcodec_open2().
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int refcounted_frames;
+
+    /* - encoding parameters */
+    float qcompress;  ///< amount of qscale change between easy & hard scenes (0.0-1.0)
+    float qblur;      ///< amount of qscale smoothing over time (0.0-1.0)
+
+    /**
+     * minimum quantizer
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int qmin;
+
+    /**
+     * maximum quantizer
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int qmax;
+
+    /**
+     * maximum quantizer difference between frames
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int max_qdiff;
+
+    /**
+     * decoder bitstream buffer size
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int rc_buffer_size;
+
+    /**
+     * ratecontrol override, see RcOverride
+     * - encoding: Allocated/set/freed by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int rc_override_count;
+    RcOverride *rc_override;
+
+    /**
+     * maximum bitrate
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user, may be overwritten by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int64_t rc_max_rate;
+
+    /**
+     * minimum bitrate
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int64_t rc_min_rate;
+
+    /**
+     * Ratecontrol attempt to use, at maximum, <value> of what can be used without an underflow.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused.
+     */
+    float rc_max_available_vbv_use;
+
+    /**
+     * Ratecontrol attempt to use, at least, <value> times the amount needed to prevent a vbv overflow.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused.
+     */
+    float rc_min_vbv_overflow_use;
+
+    /**
+     * Number of bits which should be loaded into the rc buffer before decoding starts.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int rc_initial_buffer_occupancy;
+
+#if FF_API_CODER_TYPE
+#define FF_CODER_TYPE_VLC       0
+#define FF_CODER_TYPE_AC        1
+#define FF_CODER_TYPE_RAW       2
+#define FF_CODER_TYPE_RLE       3
+    /**
+     * @deprecated use encoder private options instead
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int coder_type;
+#endif /* FF_API_CODER_TYPE */
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int context_model;
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int frame_skip_threshold;
+
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int frame_skip_factor;
+
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int frame_skip_exp;
+
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int frame_skip_cmp;
+#endif /* FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT */
+
+    /**
+     * trellis RD quantization
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int trellis;
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int min_prediction_order;
+
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int max_prediction_order;
+
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int64_t timecode_frame_start;
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_RTP_CALLBACK
+    /**
+     * @deprecated unused
+     */
+    /* The RTP callback: This function is called    */
+    /* every time the encoder has a packet to send. */
+    /* It depends on the encoder if the data starts */
+    /* with a Start Code (it should). H.263 does.   */
+    /* mb_nb contains the number of macroblocks     */
+    /* encoded in the RTP payload.                  */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    void (*rtp_callback)(struct AVCodecContext *avctx, void *data, int size, int mb_nb);
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+    /** @deprecated use encoder private options instead */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int rtp_payload_size;   /* The size of the RTP payload: the coder will  */
+                            /* do its best to deliver a chunk with size     */
+                            /* below rtp_payload_size, the chunk will start */
+                            /* with a start code on some codecs like H.263. */
+                            /* This doesn't take account of any particular  */
+                            /* headers inside the transmitted RTP payload.  */
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_STAT_BITS
+    /* statistics, used for 2-pass encoding */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int mv_bits;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int header_bits;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int i_tex_bits;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int p_tex_bits;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int i_count;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int p_count;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int skip_count;
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int misc_bits;
+
+    /** @deprecated this field is unused */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int frame_bits;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * pass1 encoding statistics output buffer
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    char *stats_out;
+
+    /**
+     * pass2 encoding statistics input buffer
+     * Concatenated stuff from stats_out of pass1 should be placed here.
+     * - encoding: Allocated/set/freed by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    char *stats_in;
+
+    /**
+     * Work around bugs in encoders which sometimes cannot be detected automatically.
+     * - encoding: Set by user
+     * - decoding: Set by user
+     */
+    int workaround_bugs;
+#define FF_BUG_AUTODETECT       1  ///< autodetection
+#define FF_BUG_XVID_ILACE       4
+#define FF_BUG_UMP4             8
+#define FF_BUG_NO_PADDING       16
+#define FF_BUG_AMV              32
+#define FF_BUG_QPEL_CHROMA      64
+#define FF_BUG_STD_QPEL         128
+#define FF_BUG_QPEL_CHROMA2     256
+#define FF_BUG_DIRECT_BLOCKSIZE 512
+#define FF_BUG_EDGE             1024
+#define FF_BUG_HPEL_CHROMA      2048
+#define FF_BUG_DC_CLIP          4096
+#define FF_BUG_MS               8192 ///< Work around various bugs in Microsoft's broken decoders.
+#define FF_BUG_TRUNCATED       16384
+#define FF_BUG_IEDGE           32768
+
+    /**
+     * strictly follow the standard (MPEG-4, ...).
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     * Setting this to STRICT or higher means the encoder and decoder will
+     * generally do stupid things, whereas setting it to unofficial or lower
+     * will mean the encoder might produce output that is not supported by all
+     * spec-compliant decoders. Decoders don't differentiate between normal,
+     * unofficial and experimental (that is, they always try to decode things
+     * when they can) unless they are explicitly asked to behave stupidly
+     * (=strictly conform to the specs)
+     */
+    int strict_std_compliance;
+#define FF_COMPLIANCE_VERY_STRICT   2 ///< Strictly conform to an older more strict version of the spec or reference software.
+#define FF_COMPLIANCE_STRICT        1 ///< Strictly conform to all the things in the spec no matter what consequences.
+#define FF_COMPLIANCE_NORMAL        0
+#define FF_COMPLIANCE_UNOFFICIAL   -1 ///< Allow unofficial extensions
+#define FF_COMPLIANCE_EXPERIMENTAL -2 ///< Allow nonstandardized experimental things.
+
+    /**
+     * error concealment flags
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int error_concealment;
+#define FF_EC_GUESS_MVS   1
+#define FF_EC_DEBLOCK     2
+#define FF_EC_FAVOR_INTER 256
+
+    /**
+     * debug
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int debug;
+#define FF_DEBUG_PICT_INFO   1
+#define FF_DEBUG_RC          2
+#define FF_DEBUG_BITSTREAM   4
+#define FF_DEBUG_MB_TYPE     8
+#define FF_DEBUG_QP          16
+#if FF_API_DEBUG_MV
+/**
+ * @deprecated this option does nothing
+ */
+#define FF_DEBUG_MV          32
+#endif
+#define FF_DEBUG_DCT_COEFF   0x00000040
+#define FF_DEBUG_SKIP        0x00000080
+#define FF_DEBUG_STARTCODE   0x00000100
+#define FF_DEBUG_ER          0x00000400
+#define FF_DEBUG_MMCO        0x00000800
+#define FF_DEBUG_BUGS        0x00001000
+#if FF_API_DEBUG_MV
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_QP      0x00002000
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MB_TYPE 0x00004000
+#endif
+#define FF_DEBUG_BUFFERS     0x00008000
+#define FF_DEBUG_THREADS     0x00010000
+#define FF_DEBUG_GREEN_MD    0x00800000
+#define FF_DEBUG_NOMC        0x01000000
+
+#if FF_API_DEBUG_MV
+    /**
+     * debug
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int debug_mv;
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MV_P_FOR  0x00000001 // visualize forward predicted MVs of P-frames
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MV_B_FOR  0x00000002 // visualize forward predicted MVs of B-frames
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MV_B_BACK 0x00000004 // visualize backward predicted MVs of B-frames
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * Error recognition; may misdetect some more or less valid parts as errors.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int err_recognition;
+
+/**
+ * Verify checksums embedded in the bitstream (could be of either encoded or
+ * decoded data, depending on the codec) and print an error message on mismatch.
+ * If AV_EF_EXPLODE is also set, a mismatching checksum will result in the
+ * decoder returning an error.
+ */
+#define AV_EF_CRCCHECK  (1<<0)
+#define AV_EF_BITSTREAM (1<<1)          ///< detect bitstream specification deviations
+#define AV_EF_BUFFER    (1<<2)          ///< detect improper bitstream length
+#define AV_EF_EXPLODE   (1<<3)          ///< abort decoding on minor error detection
+
+#define AV_EF_IGNORE_ERR (1<<15)        ///< ignore errors and continue
+#define AV_EF_CAREFUL    (1<<16)        ///< consider things that violate the spec, are fast to calculate and have not been seen in the wild as errors
+#define AV_EF_COMPLIANT  (1<<17)        ///< consider all spec non compliances as errors
+#define AV_EF_AGGRESSIVE (1<<18)        ///< consider things that a sane encoder should not do as an error
+
+
+    /**
+     * opaque 64-bit number (generally a PTS) that will be reordered and
+     * output in AVFrame.reordered_opaque
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int64_t reordered_opaque;
+
+    /**
+     * Hardware accelerator in use
+     * - encoding: unused.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec
+     */
+    const struct AVHWAccel *hwaccel;
+
+    /**
+     * Hardware accelerator context.
+     * For some hardware accelerators, a global context needs to be
+     * provided by the user. In that case, this holds display-dependent
+     * data FFmpeg cannot instantiate itself. Please refer to the
+     * FFmpeg HW accelerator documentation to know how to fill this
+     * is. e.g. for VA API, this is a struct vaapi_context.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user
+     */
+    void *hwaccel_context;
+
+    /**
+     * error
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec if flags & AV_CODEC_FLAG_PSNR.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    uint64_t error[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];
+
+    /**
+     * DCT algorithm, see FF_DCT_* below
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+    int dct_algo;
+#define FF_DCT_AUTO    0
+#define FF_DCT_FASTINT 1
+#define FF_DCT_INT     2
+#define FF_DCT_MMX     3
+#define FF_DCT_ALTIVEC 5
+#define FF_DCT_FAAN    6
+
+    /**
+     * IDCT algorithm, see FF_IDCT_* below.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int idct_algo;
+#define FF_IDCT_AUTO          0
+#define FF_IDCT_INT           1
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLE        2
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLEMMX     3
+#define FF_IDCT_ARM           7
+#define FF_IDCT_ALTIVEC       8
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLEARM     10
+#define FF_IDCT_XVID          14
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLEARMV5TE 16
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLEARMV6   17
+#define FF_IDCT_FAAN          20
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLENEON    22
+#define FF_IDCT_NONE          24 /* Used by XvMC to extract IDCT coefficients with FF_IDCT_PERM_NONE */
+#define FF_IDCT_SIMPLEAUTO    128
+
+    /**
+     * bits per sample/pixel from the demuxer (needed for huffyuv).
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+     int bits_per_coded_sample;
+
+    /**
+     * Bits per sample/pixel of internal libavcodec pixel/sample format.
+     * - encoding: set by user.
+     * - decoding: set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int bits_per_raw_sample;
+
+#if FF_API_LOWRES
+    /**
+     * low resolution decoding, 1-> 1/2 size, 2->1/4 size
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+     int lowres;
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_CODED_FRAME
+    /**
+     * the picture in the bitstream
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     *
+     * @deprecated use the quality factor packet side data instead
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated AVFrame *coded_frame;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * thread count
+     * is used to decide how many independent tasks should be passed to execute()
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int thread_count;
+
+    /**
+     * Which multithreading methods to use.
+     * Use of FF_THREAD_FRAME will increase decoding delay by one frame per thread,
+     * so clients which cannot provide future frames should not use it.
+     *
+     * - encoding: Set by user, otherwise the default is used.
+     * - decoding: Set by user, otherwise the default is used.
+     */
+    int thread_type;
+#define FF_THREAD_FRAME   1 ///< Decode more than one frame at once
+#define FF_THREAD_SLICE   2 ///< Decode more than one part of a single frame at once
+
+    /**
+     * Which multithreading methods are in use by the codec.
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    int active_thread_type;
+
+    /**
+     * Set by the client if its custom get_buffer() callback can be called
+     * synchronously from another thread, which allows faster multithreaded decoding.
+     * draw_horiz_band() will be called from other threads regardless of this setting.
+     * Ignored if the default get_buffer() is used.
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int thread_safe_callbacks;
+
+    /**
+     * The codec may call this to execute several independent things.
+     * It will return only after finishing all tasks.
+     * The user may replace this with some multithreaded implementation,
+     * the default implementation will execute the parts serially.
+     * @param count the number of things to execute
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec, user can override.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec, user can override.
+     */
+    int (*execute)(struct AVCodecContext *c, int (*func)(struct AVCodecContext *c2, void *arg), void *arg2, int *ret, int count, int size);
+
+    /**
+     * The codec may call this to execute several independent things.
+     * It will return only after finishing all tasks.
+     * The user may replace this with some multithreaded implementation,
+     * the default implementation will execute the parts serially.
+     * Also see avcodec_thread_init and e.g. the --enable-pthread configure option.
+     * @param c context passed also to func
+     * @param count the number of things to execute
+     * @param arg2 argument passed unchanged to func
+     * @param ret return values of executed functions, must have space for "count" values. May be NULL.
+     * @param func function that will be called count times, with jobnr from 0 to count-1.
+     *             threadnr will be in the range 0 to c->thread_count-1 < MAX_THREADS and so that no
+     *             two instances of func executing at the same time will have the same threadnr.
+     * @return always 0 currently, but code should handle a future improvement where when any call to func
+     *         returns < 0 no further calls to func may be done and < 0 is returned.
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec, user can override.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec, user can override.
+     */
+    int (*execute2)(struct AVCodecContext *c, int (*func)(struct AVCodecContext *c2, void *arg, int jobnr, int threadnr), void *arg2, int *ret, int count);
+
+    /**
+     * noise vs. sse weight for the nsse comparison function
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: unused
+     */
+     int nsse_weight;
+
+    /**
+     * profile
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+     int profile;
+#define FF_PROFILE_UNKNOWN -99
+#define FF_PROFILE_RESERVED -100
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_MAIN 0
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_LOW  1
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_SSR  2
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_LTP  3
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_HE   4
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_HE_V2 28
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_LD   22
+#define FF_PROFILE_AAC_ELD  38
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_AAC_LOW 128
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_AAC_HE  131
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_DNXHD         0
+#define FF_PROFILE_DNXHR_LB      1
+#define FF_PROFILE_DNXHR_SQ      2
+#define FF_PROFILE_DNXHR_HQ      3
+#define FF_PROFILE_DNXHR_HQX     4
+#define FF_PROFILE_DNXHR_444     5
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_DTS         20
+#define FF_PROFILE_DTS_ES      30
+#define FF_PROFILE_DTS_96_24   40
+#define FF_PROFILE_DTS_HD_HRA  50
+#define FF_PROFILE_DTS_HD_MA   60
+#define FF_PROFILE_DTS_EXPRESS 70
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_422    0
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_HIGH   1
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_SS     2
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_SNR_SCALABLE  3
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_MAIN   4
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG2_SIMPLE 5
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_CONSTRAINED  (1<<9)  // 8+1; constraint_set1_flag
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_INTRA        (1<<11) // 8+3; constraint_set3_flag
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_BASELINE             66
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_CONSTRAINED_BASELINE (66|FF_PROFILE_H264_CONSTRAINED)
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_MAIN                 77
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_EXTENDED             88
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH                 100
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_10              110
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_10_INTRA        (110|FF_PROFILE_H264_INTRA)
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_MULTIVIEW_HIGH       118
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_422             122
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_422_INTRA       (122|FF_PROFILE_H264_INTRA)
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_STEREO_HIGH          128
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_444             144
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_444_PREDICTIVE  244
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_HIGH_444_INTRA       (244|FF_PROFILE_H264_INTRA)
+#define FF_PROFILE_H264_CAVLC_444            44
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_VC1_SIMPLE   0
+#define FF_PROFILE_VC1_MAIN     1
+#define FF_PROFILE_VC1_COMPLEX  2
+#define FF_PROFILE_VC1_ADVANCED 3
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE                     0
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE_SCALABLE            1
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_CORE                       2
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_MAIN                       3
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_N_BIT                      4
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_SCALABLE_TEXTURE           5
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE_FACE_ANIMATION      6
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_BASIC_ANIMATED_TEXTURE     7
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_HYBRID                     8
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_REAL_TIME         9
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_CORE_SCALABLE             10
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_CODING           11
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_CORE             12
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_SCALABLE_TEXTURE 13
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_SIMPLE_STUDIO             14
+#define FF_PROFILE_MPEG4_ADVANCED_SIMPLE           15
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_JPEG2000_CSTREAM_RESTRICTION_0   1
+#define FF_PROFILE_JPEG2000_CSTREAM_RESTRICTION_1   2
+#define FF_PROFILE_JPEG2000_CSTREAM_NO_RESTRICTION  32768
+#define FF_PROFILE_JPEG2000_DCINEMA_2K              3
+#define FF_PROFILE_JPEG2000_DCINEMA_4K              4
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_VP9_0                            0
+#define FF_PROFILE_VP9_1                            1
+#define FF_PROFILE_VP9_2                            2
+#define FF_PROFILE_VP9_3                            3
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_HEVC_MAIN                        1
+#define FF_PROFILE_HEVC_MAIN_10                     2
+#define FF_PROFILE_HEVC_MAIN_STILL_PICTURE          3
+#define FF_PROFILE_HEVC_REXT                        4
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_AV1_MAIN                         0
+#define FF_PROFILE_AV1_HIGH                         1
+#define FF_PROFILE_AV1_PROFESSIONAL                 2
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_BASELINE_DCT            0xc0
+#define FF_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_EXTENDED_SEQUENTIAL_DCT 0xc1
+#define FF_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_PROGRESSIVE_DCT         0xc2
+#define FF_PROFILE_MJPEG_HUFFMAN_LOSSLESS                0xc3
+#define FF_PROFILE_MJPEG_JPEG_LS                         0xf7
+
+#define FF_PROFILE_SBC_MSBC                         1
+
+    /**
+     * level
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     */
+     int level;
+#define FF_LEVEL_UNKNOWN -99
+
+    /**
+     * Skip loop filtering for selected frames.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    enum AVDiscard skip_loop_filter;
+
+    /**
+     * Skip IDCT/dequantization for selected frames.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    enum AVDiscard skip_idct;
+
+    /**
+     * Skip decoding for selected frames.
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    enum AVDiscard skip_frame;
+
+    /**
+     * Header containing style information for text subtitles.
+     * For SUBTITLE_ASS subtitle type, it should contain the whole ASS
+     * [Script Info] and [V4+ Styles] section, plus the [Events] line and
+     * the Format line following. It shouldn't include any Dialogue line.
+     * - encoding: Set/allocated/freed by user (before avcodec_open2())
+     * - decoding: Set/allocated/freed by libavcodec (by avcodec_open2())
+     */
+    uint8_t *subtitle_header;
+    int subtitle_header_size;
+
+#if FF_API_VBV_DELAY
+    /**
+     * VBV delay coded in the last frame (in periods of a 27 MHz clock).
+     * Used for compliant TS muxing.
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec.
+     * - decoding: unused.
+     * @deprecated this value is now exported as a part of
+     * AV_PKT_DATA_CPB_PROPERTIES packet side data
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    uint64_t vbv_delay;
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_SIDEDATA_ONLY_PKT
+    /**
+     * Encoding only and set by default. Allow encoders to output packets
+     * that do not contain any encoded data, only side data.
+     *
+     * Some encoders need to output such packets, e.g. to update some stream
+     * parameters at the end of encoding.
+     *
+     * @deprecated this field disables the default behaviour and
+     *             it is kept only for compatibility.
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int side_data_only_packets;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The number of "priming" samples (padding) inserted by the
+     * encoder at the beginning of the audio. I.e. this number of leading
+     * decoded samples must be discarded by the caller to get the original audio
+     * without leading padding.
+     *
+     * - decoding: unused
+     * - encoding: Set by libavcodec. The timestamps on the output packets are
+     *             adjusted by the encoder so that they always refer to the
+     *             first sample of the data actually contained in the packet,
+     *             including any added padding.  E.g. if the timebase is
+     *             1/samplerate and the timestamp of the first input sample is
+     *             0, the timestamp of the first output packet will be
+     *             -initial_padding.
+     */
+    int initial_padding;
+
+    /**
+     * - decoding: For codecs that store a framerate value in the compressed
+     *             bitstream, the decoder may export it here. { 0, 1} when
+     *             unknown.
+     * - encoding: May be used to signal the framerate of CFR content to an
+     *             encoder.
+     */
+    AVRational framerate;
+
+    /**
+     * Nominal unaccelerated pixel format, see AV_PIX_FMT_xxx.
+     * - encoding: unused.
+     * - decoding: Set by libavcodec before calling get_format()
+     */
+    enum AVPixelFormat sw_pix_fmt;
+
+    /**
+     * Timebase in which pkt_dts/pts and AVPacket.dts/pts are.
+     * - encoding unused.
+     * - decoding set by user.
+     */
+    AVRational pkt_timebase;
+
+    /**
+     * AVCodecDescriptor
+     * - encoding: unused.
+     * - decoding: set by libavcodec.
+     */
+    const AVCodecDescriptor *codec_descriptor;
+
+#if !FF_API_LOWRES
+    /**
+     * low resolution decoding, 1-> 1/2 size, 2->1/4 size
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+     int lowres;
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * Current statistics for PTS correction.
+     * - decoding: maintained and used by libavcodec, not intended to be used by user apps
+     * - encoding: unused
+     */
+    int64_t pts_correction_num_faulty_pts; /// Number of incorrect PTS values so far
+    int64_t pts_correction_num_faulty_dts; /// Number of incorrect DTS values so far
+    int64_t pts_correction_last_pts;       /// PTS of the last frame
+    int64_t pts_correction_last_dts;       /// DTS of the last frame
+
+    /**
+     * Character encoding of the input subtitles file.
+     * - decoding: set by user
+     * - encoding: unused
+     */
+    char *sub_charenc;
+
+    /**
+     * Subtitles character encoding mode. Formats or codecs might be adjusting
+     * this setting (if they are doing the conversion themselves for instance).
+     * - decoding: set by libavcodec
+     * - encoding: unused
+     */
+    int sub_charenc_mode;
+#define FF_SUB_CHARENC_MODE_DO_NOTHING  -1  ///< do nothing (demuxer outputs a stream supposed to be already in UTF-8, or the codec is bitmap for instance)
+#define FF_SUB_CHARENC_MODE_AUTOMATIC    0  ///< libavcodec will select the mode itself
+#define FF_SUB_CHARENC_MODE_PRE_DECODER  1  ///< the AVPacket data needs to be recoded to UTF-8 before being fed to the decoder, requires iconv
+#define FF_SUB_CHARENC_MODE_IGNORE       2  ///< neither convert the subtitles, nor check them for valid UTF-8
+
+    /**
+     * Skip processing alpha if supported by codec.
+     * Note that if the format uses pre-multiplied alpha (common with VP6,
+     * and recommended due to better video quality/compression)
+     * the image will look as if alpha-blended onto a black background.
+     * However for formats that do not use pre-multiplied alpha
+     * there might be serious artefacts (though e.g. libswscale currently
+     * assumes pre-multiplied alpha anyway).
+     *
+     * - decoding: set by user
+     * - encoding: unused
+     */
+    int skip_alpha;
+
+    /**
+     * Number of samples to skip after a discontinuity
+     * - decoding: unused
+     * - encoding: set by libavcodec
+     */
+    int seek_preroll;
+
+#if !FF_API_DEBUG_MV
+    /**
+     * debug motion vectors
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    int debug_mv;
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MV_P_FOR  0x00000001 //visualize forward predicted MVs of P frames
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MV_B_FOR  0x00000002 //visualize forward predicted MVs of B frames
+#define FF_DEBUG_VIS_MV_B_BACK 0x00000004 //visualize backward predicted MVs of B frames
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * custom intra quantization matrix
+     * - encoding: Set by user, can be NULL.
+     * - decoding: unused.
+     */
+    uint16_t *chroma_intra_matrix;
+
+    /**
+     * dump format separator.
+     * can be ", " or "\n      " or anything else
+     * - encoding: Set by user.
+     * - decoding: Set by user.
+     */
+    uint8_t *dump_separator;
+
+    /**
+     * ',' separated list of allowed decoders.
+     * If NULL then all are allowed
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: set by user
+     */
+    char *codec_whitelist;
+
+    /**
+     * Properties of the stream that gets decoded
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: set by libavcodec
+     */
+    unsigned properties;
+#define FF_CODEC_PROPERTY_LOSSLESS        0x00000001
+#define FF_CODEC_PROPERTY_CLOSED_CAPTIONS 0x00000002
+
+    /**
+     * Additional data associated with the entire coded stream.
+     *
+     * - decoding: unused
+     * - encoding: may be set by libavcodec after avcodec_open2().
+     */
+    AVPacketSideData *coded_side_data;
+    int            nb_coded_side_data;
+
+    /**
+     * A reference to the AVHWFramesContext describing the input (for encoding)
+     * or output (decoding) frames. The reference is set by the caller and
+     * afterwards owned (and freed) by libavcodec - it should never be read by
+     * the caller after being set.
+     *
+     * - decoding: This field should be set by the caller from the get_format()
+     *             callback. The previous reference (if any) will always be
+     *             unreffed by libavcodec before the get_format() call.
+     *
+     *             If the default get_buffer2() is used with a hwaccel pixel
+     *             format, then this AVHWFramesContext will be used for
+     *             allocating the frame buffers.
+     *
+     * - encoding: For hardware encoders configured to use a hwaccel pixel
+     *             format, this field should be set by the caller to a reference
+     *             to the AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
+     *             AVHWFramesContext.format must be equal to
+     *             AVCodecContext.pix_fmt.
+     *
+     *             This field should be set before avcodec_open2() is called.
+     */
+    AVBufferRef *hw_frames_ctx;
+
+    /**
+     * Control the form of AVSubtitle.rects[N]->ass
+     * - decoding: set by user
+     * - encoding: unused
+     */
+    int sub_text_format;
+#define FF_SUB_TEXT_FMT_ASS              0
+#if FF_API_ASS_TIMING
+#define FF_SUB_TEXT_FMT_ASS_WITH_TIMINGS 1
+#endif
+
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The amount of padding (in samples) appended by the encoder to
+     * the end of the audio. I.e. this number of decoded samples must be
+     * discarded by the caller from the end of the stream to get the original
+     * audio without any trailing padding.
+     *
+     * - decoding: unused
+     * - encoding: unused
+     */
+    int trailing_padding;
+
+    /**
+     * The number of pixels per image to maximally accept.
+     *
+     * - decoding: set by user
+     * - encoding: set by user
+     */
+    int64_t max_pixels;
+
+    /**
+     * A reference to the AVHWDeviceContext describing the device which will
+     * be used by a hardware encoder/decoder.  The reference is set by the
+     * caller and afterwards owned (and freed) by libavcodec.
+     *
+     * This should be used if either the codec device does not require
+     * hardware frames or any that are used are to be allocated internally by
+     * libavcodec.  If the user wishes to supply any of the frames used as
+     * encoder input or decoder output then hw_frames_ctx should be used
+     * instead.  When hw_frames_ctx is set in get_format() for a decoder, this
+     * field will be ignored while decoding the associated stream segment, but
+     * may again be used on a following one after another get_format() call.
+     *
+     * For both encoders and decoders this field should be set before
+     * avcodec_open2() is called and must not be written to thereafter.
+     *
+     * Note that some decoders may require this field to be set initially in
+     * order to support hw_frames_ctx at all - in that case, all frames
+     * contexts used must be created on the same device.
+     */
+    AVBufferRef *hw_device_ctx;
+
+    /**
+     * Bit set of AV_HWACCEL_FLAG_* flags, which affect hardware accelerated
+     * decoding (if active).
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user (either before avcodec_open2(), or in the
+     *             AVCodecContext.get_format callback)
+     */
+    int hwaccel_flags;
+
+    /**
+     * Video decoding only. Certain video codecs support cropping, meaning that
+     * only a sub-rectangle of the decoded frame is intended for display.  This
+     * option controls how cropping is handled by libavcodec.
+     *
+     * When set to 1 (the default), libavcodec will apply cropping internally.
+     * I.e. it will modify the output frame width/height fields and offset the
+     * data pointers (only by as much as possible while preserving alignment, or
+     * by the full amount if the AV_CODEC_FLAG_UNALIGNED flag is set) so that
+     * the frames output by the decoder refer only to the cropped area. The
+     * crop_* fields of the output frames will be zero.
+     *
+     * When set to 0, the width/height fields of the output frames will be set
+     * to the coded dimensions and the crop_* fields will describe the cropping
+     * rectangle. Applying the cropping is left to the caller.
+     *
+     * @warning When hardware acceleration with opaque output frames is used,
+     * libavcodec is unable to apply cropping from the top/left border.
+     *
+     * @note when this option is set to zero, the width/height fields of the
+     * AVCodecContext and output AVFrames have different meanings. The codec
+     * context fields store display dimensions (with the coded dimensions in
+     * coded_width/height), while the frame fields store the coded dimensions
+     * (with the display dimensions being determined by the crop_* fields).
+     */
+    int apply_cropping;
+
+    /*
+     * Video decoding only.  Sets the number of extra hardware frames which
+     * the decoder will allocate for use by the caller.  This must be set
+     * before avcodec_open2() is called.
+     *
+     * Some hardware decoders require all frames that they will use for
+     * output to be defined in advance before decoding starts.  For such
+     * decoders, the hardware frame pool must therefore be of a fixed size.
+     * The extra frames set here are on top of any number that the decoder
+     * needs internally in order to operate normally (for example, frames
+     * used as reference pictures).
+     */
+    int extra_hw_frames;
+} AVCodecContext;
+
+#if FF_API_CODEC_GET_SET
+/**
+ * Accessors for some AVCodecContext fields. These used to be provided for ABI
+ * compatibility, and do not need to be used anymore.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+AVRational av_codec_get_pkt_timebase         (const AVCodecContext *avctx);
+attribute_deprecated
+void       av_codec_set_pkt_timebase         (AVCodecContext *avctx, AVRational val);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+const AVCodecDescriptor *av_codec_get_codec_descriptor(const AVCodecContext *avctx);
+attribute_deprecated
+void                     av_codec_set_codec_descriptor(AVCodecContext *avctx, const AVCodecDescriptor *desc);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+unsigned av_codec_get_codec_properties(const AVCodecContext *avctx);
+
+#if FF_API_LOWRES
+attribute_deprecated
+int  av_codec_get_lowres(const AVCodecContext *avctx);
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_codec_set_lowres(AVCodecContext *avctx, int val);
+#endif
+
+attribute_deprecated
+int  av_codec_get_seek_preroll(const AVCodecContext *avctx);
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_codec_set_seek_preroll(AVCodecContext *avctx, int val);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+uint16_t *av_codec_get_chroma_intra_matrix(const AVCodecContext *avctx);
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_codec_set_chroma_intra_matrix(AVCodecContext *avctx, uint16_t *val);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * AVProfile.
+ */
+typedef struct AVProfile {
+    int profile;
+    const char *name; ///< short name for the profile
+} AVProfile;
+
+enum {
+    /**
+     * The codec supports this format via the hw_device_ctx interface.
+     *
+     * When selecting this format, AVCodecContext.hw_device_ctx should
+     * have been set to a device of the specified type before calling
+     * avcodec_open2().
+     */
+    AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_DEVICE_CTX = 0x01,
+    /**
+     * The codec supports this format via the hw_frames_ctx interface.
+     *
+     * When selecting this format for a decoder,
+     * AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx should be set to a suitable frames
+     * context inside the get_format() callback.  The frames context
+     * must have been created on a device of the specified type.
+     */
+    AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_FRAMES_CTX = 0x02,
+    /**
+     * The codec supports this format by some internal method.
+     *
+     * This format can be selected without any additional configuration -
+     * no device or frames context is required.
+     */
+    AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_INTERNAL      = 0x04,
+    /**
+     * The codec supports this format by some ad-hoc method.
+     *
+     * Additional settings and/or function calls are required.  See the
+     * codec-specific documentation for details.  (Methods requiring
+     * this sort of configuration are deprecated and others should be
+     * used in preference.)
+     */
+    AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_AD_HOC        = 0x08,
+};
+
+typedef struct AVCodecHWConfig {
+    /**
+     * A hardware pixel format which the codec can use.
+     */
+    enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt;
+    /**
+     * Bit set of AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_* flags, describing the possible
+     * setup methods which can be used with this configuration.
+     */
+    int methods;
+    /**
+     * The device type associated with the configuration.
+     *
+     * Must be set for AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_DEVICE_CTX and
+     * AV_CODEC_HW_CONFIG_METHOD_HW_FRAMES_CTX, otherwise unused.
+     */
+    enum AVHWDeviceType device_type;
+} AVCodecHWConfig;
+
+typedef struct AVCodecDefault AVCodecDefault;
+
+struct AVSubtitle;
+
+/**
+ * AVCodec.
+ */
+typedef struct AVCodec {
+    /**
+     * Name of the codec implementation.
+     * The name is globally unique among encoders and among decoders (but an
+     * encoder and a decoder can share the same name).
+     * This is the primary way to find a codec from the user perspective.
+     */
+    const char *name;
+    /**
+     * Descriptive name for the codec, meant to be more human readable than name.
+     * You should use the NULL_IF_CONFIG_SMALL() macro to define it.
+     */
+    const char *long_name;
+    enum AVMediaType type;
+    enum AVCodecID id;
+    /**
+     * Codec capabilities.
+     * see AV_CODEC_CAP_*
+     */
+    int capabilities;
+    const AVRational *supported_framerates; ///< array of supported framerates, or NULL if any, array is terminated by {0,0}
+    const enum AVPixelFormat *pix_fmts;     ///< array of supported pixel formats, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by -1
+    const int *supported_samplerates;       ///< array of supported audio samplerates, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by 0
+    const enum AVSampleFormat *sample_fmts; ///< array of supported sample formats, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by -1
+    const uint64_t *channel_layouts;         ///< array of support channel layouts, or NULL if unknown. array is terminated by 0
+    uint8_t max_lowres;                     ///< maximum value for lowres supported by the decoder
+    const AVClass *priv_class;              ///< AVClass for the private context
+    const AVProfile *profiles;              ///< array of recognized profiles, or NULL if unknown, array is terminated by {FF_PROFILE_UNKNOWN}
+
+    /**
+     * Group name of the codec implementation.
+     * This is a short symbolic name of the wrapper backing this codec. A
+     * wrapper uses some kind of external implementation for the codec, such
+     * as an external library, or a codec implementation provided by the OS or
+     * the hardware.
+     * If this field is NULL, this is a builtin, libavcodec native codec.
+     * If non-NULL, this will be the suffix in AVCodec.name in most cases
+     * (usually AVCodec.name will be of the form "<codec_name>_<wrapper_name>").
+     */
+    const char *wrapper_name;
+
+    /*****************************************************************
+     * No fields below this line are part of the public API. They
+     * may not be used outside of libavcodec and can be changed and
+     * removed at will.
+     * New public fields should be added right above.
+     *****************************************************************
+     */
+    int priv_data_size;
+    struct AVCodec *next;
+    /**
+     * @name Frame-level threading support functions
+     * @{
+     */
+    /**
+     * If defined, called on thread contexts when they are created.
+     * If the codec allocates writable tables in init(), re-allocate them here.
+     * priv_data will be set to a copy of the original.
+     */
+    int (*init_thread_copy)(AVCodecContext *);
+    /**
+     * Copy necessary context variables from a previous thread context to the current one.
+     * If not defined, the next thread will start automatically; otherwise, the codec
+     * must call ff_thread_finish_setup().
+     *
+     * dst and src will (rarely) point to the same context, in which case memcpy should be skipped.
+     */
+    int (*update_thread_context)(AVCodecContext *dst, const AVCodecContext *src);
+    /** @} */
+
+    /**
+     * Private codec-specific defaults.
+     */
+    const AVCodecDefault *defaults;
+
+    /**
+     * Initialize codec static data, called from avcodec_register().
+     *
+     * This is not intended for time consuming operations as it is
+     * run for every codec regardless of that codec being used.
+     */
+    void (*init_static_data)(struct AVCodec *codec);
+
+    int (*init)(AVCodecContext *);
+    int (*encode_sub)(AVCodecContext *, uint8_t *buf, int buf_size,
+                      const struct AVSubtitle *sub);
+    /**
+     * Encode data to an AVPacket.
+     *
+     * @param      avctx          codec context
+     * @param      avpkt          output AVPacket (may contain a user-provided buffer)
+     * @param[in]  frame          AVFrame containing the raw data to be encoded
+     * @param[out] got_packet_ptr encoder sets to 0 or 1 to indicate that a
+     *                            non-empty packet was returned in avpkt.
+     * @return 0 on success, negative error code on failure
+     */
+    int (*encode2)(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVPacket *avpkt, const AVFrame *frame,
+                   int *got_packet_ptr);
+    int (*decode)(AVCodecContext *, void *outdata, int *outdata_size, AVPacket *avpkt);
+    int (*close)(AVCodecContext *);
+    /**
+     * Encode API with decoupled packet/frame dataflow. The API is the
+     * same as the avcodec_ prefixed APIs (avcodec_send_frame() etc.), except
+     * that:
+     * - never called if the codec is closed or the wrong type,
+     * - if AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY is not set, drain frames are never sent,
+     * - only one drain frame is ever passed down,
+     */
+    int (*send_frame)(AVCodecContext *avctx, const AVFrame *frame);
+    int (*receive_packet)(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVPacket *avpkt);
+
+    /**
+     * Decode API with decoupled packet/frame dataflow. This function is called
+     * to get one output frame. It should call ff_decode_get_packet() to obtain
+     * input data.
+     */
+    int (*receive_frame)(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVFrame *frame);
+    /**
+     * Flush buffers.
+     * Will be called when seeking
+     */
+    void (*flush)(AVCodecContext *);
+    /**
+     * Internal codec capabilities.
+     * See FF_CODEC_CAP_* in internal.h
+     */
+    int caps_internal;
+
+    /**
+     * Decoding only, a comma-separated list of bitstream filters to apply to
+     * packets before decoding.
+     */
+    const char *bsfs;
+
+    /**
+     * Array of pointers to hardware configurations supported by the codec,
+     * or NULL if no hardware supported.  The array is terminated by a NULL
+     * pointer.
+     *
+     * The user can only access this field via avcodec_get_hw_config().
+     */
+    const struct AVCodecHWConfigInternal **hw_configs;
+} AVCodec;
+
+#if FF_API_CODEC_GET_SET
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_codec_get_max_lowres(const AVCodec *codec);
+#endif
+
+struct MpegEncContext;
+
+/**
+ * Retrieve supported hardware configurations for a codec.
+ *
+ * Values of index from zero to some maximum return the indexed configuration
+ * descriptor; all other values return NULL.  If the codec does not support
+ * any hardware configurations then it will always return NULL.
+ */
+const AVCodecHWConfig *avcodec_get_hw_config(const AVCodec *codec, int index);
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_hwaccel AVHWAccel
+ *
+ * @note  Nothing in this structure should be accessed by the user.  At some
+ *        point in future it will not be externally visible at all.
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+typedef struct AVHWAccel {
+    /**
+     * Name of the hardware accelerated codec.
+     * The name is globally unique among encoders and among decoders (but an
+     * encoder and a decoder can share the same name).
+     */
+    const char *name;
+
+    /**
+     * Type of codec implemented by the hardware accelerator.
+     *
+     * See AVMEDIA_TYPE_xxx
+     */
+    enum AVMediaType type;
+
+    /**
+     * Codec implemented by the hardware accelerator.
+     *
+     * See AV_CODEC_ID_xxx
+     */
+    enum AVCodecID id;
+
+    /**
+     * Supported pixel format.
+     *
+     * Only hardware accelerated formats are supported here.
+     */
+    enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt;
+
+    /**
+     * Hardware accelerated codec capabilities.
+     * see AV_HWACCEL_CODEC_CAP_*
+     */
+    int capabilities;
+
+    /*****************************************************************
+     * No fields below this line are part of the public API. They
+     * may not be used outside of libavcodec and can be changed and
+     * removed at will.
+     * New public fields should be added right above.
+     *****************************************************************
+     */
+
+    /**
+     * Allocate a custom buffer
+     */
+    int (*alloc_frame)(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVFrame *frame);
+
+    /**
+     * Called at the beginning of each frame or field picture.
+     *
+     * Meaningful frame information (codec specific) is guaranteed to
+     * be parsed at this point. This function is mandatory.
+     *
+     * Note that buf can be NULL along with buf_size set to 0.
+     * Otherwise, this means the whole frame is available at this point.
+     *
+     * @param avctx the codec context
+     * @param buf the frame data buffer base
+     * @param buf_size the size of the frame in bytes
+     * @return zero if successful, a negative value otherwise
+     */
+    int (*start_frame)(AVCodecContext *avctx, const uint8_t *buf, uint32_t buf_size);
+
+    /**
+     * Callback for parameter data (SPS/PPS/VPS etc).
+     *
+     * Useful for hardware decoders which keep persistent state about the
+     * video parameters, and need to receive any changes to update that state.
+     *
+     * @param avctx the codec context
+     * @param type the nal unit type
+     * @param buf the nal unit data buffer
+     * @param buf_size the size of the nal unit in bytes
+     * @return zero if successful, a negative value otherwise
+     */
+    int (*decode_params)(AVCodecContext *avctx, int type, const uint8_t *buf, uint32_t buf_size);
+
+    /**
+     * Callback for each slice.
+     *
+     * Meaningful slice information (codec specific) is guaranteed to
+     * be parsed at this point. This function is mandatory.
+     * The only exception is XvMC, that works on MB level.
+     *
+     * @param avctx the codec context
+     * @param buf the slice data buffer base
+     * @param buf_size the size of the slice in bytes
+     * @return zero if successful, a negative value otherwise
+     */
+    int (*decode_slice)(AVCodecContext *avctx, const uint8_t *buf, uint32_t buf_size);
+
+    /**
+     * Called at the end of each frame or field picture.
+     *
+     * The whole picture is parsed at this point and can now be sent
+     * to the hardware accelerator. This function is mandatory.
+     *
+     * @param avctx the codec context
+     * @return zero if successful, a negative value otherwise
+     */
+    int (*end_frame)(AVCodecContext *avctx);
+
+    /**
+     * Size of per-frame hardware accelerator private data.
+     *
+     * Private data is allocated with av_mallocz() before
+     * AVCodecContext.get_buffer() and deallocated after
+     * AVCodecContext.release_buffer().
+     */
+    int frame_priv_data_size;
+
+    /**
+     * Called for every Macroblock in a slice.
+     *
+     * XvMC uses it to replace the ff_mpv_reconstruct_mb().
+     * Instead of decoding to raw picture, MB parameters are
+     * stored in an array provided by the video driver.
+     *
+     * @param s the mpeg context
+     */
+    void (*decode_mb)(struct MpegEncContext *s);
+
+    /**
+     * Initialize the hwaccel private data.
+     *
+     * This will be called from ff_get_format(), after hwaccel and
+     * hwaccel_context are set and the hwaccel private data in AVCodecInternal
+     * is allocated.
+     */
+    int (*init)(AVCodecContext *avctx);
+
+    /**
+     * Uninitialize the hwaccel private data.
+     *
+     * This will be called from get_format() or avcodec_close(), after hwaccel
+     * and hwaccel_context are already uninitialized.
+     */
+    int (*uninit)(AVCodecContext *avctx);
+
+    /**
+     * Size of the private data to allocate in
+     * AVCodecInternal.hwaccel_priv_data.
+     */
+    int priv_data_size;
+
+    /**
+     * Internal hwaccel capabilities.
+     */
+    int caps_internal;
+
+    /**
+     * Fill the given hw_frames context with current codec parameters. Called
+     * from get_format. Refer to avcodec_get_hw_frames_parameters() for
+     * details.
+     *
+     * This CAN be called before AVHWAccel.init is called, and you must assume
+     * that avctx->hwaccel_priv_data is invalid.
+     */
+    int (*frame_params)(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVBufferRef *hw_frames_ctx);
+} AVHWAccel;
+
+/**
+ * HWAccel is experimental and is thus avoided in favor of non experimental
+ * codecs
+ */
+#define AV_HWACCEL_CODEC_CAP_EXPERIMENTAL 0x0200
+
+/**
+ * Hardware acceleration should be used for decoding even if the codec level
+ * used is unknown or higher than the maximum supported level reported by the
+ * hardware driver.
+ *
+ * It's generally a good idea to pass this flag unless you have a specific
+ * reason not to, as hardware tends to under-report supported levels.
+ */
+#define AV_HWACCEL_FLAG_IGNORE_LEVEL (1 << 0)
+
+/**
+ * Hardware acceleration can output YUV pixel formats with a different chroma
+ * sampling than 4:2:0 and/or other than 8 bits per component.
+ */
+#define AV_HWACCEL_FLAG_ALLOW_HIGH_DEPTH (1 << 1)
+
+/**
+ * Hardware acceleration should still be attempted for decoding when the
+ * codec profile does not match the reported capabilities of the hardware.
+ *
+ * For example, this can be used to try to decode baseline profile H.264
+ * streams in hardware - it will often succeed, because many streams marked
+ * as baseline profile actually conform to constrained baseline profile.
+ *
+ * @warning If the stream is actually not supported then the behaviour is
+ *          undefined, and may include returning entirely incorrect output
+ *          while indicating success.
+ */
+#define AV_HWACCEL_FLAG_ALLOW_PROFILE_MISMATCH (1 << 2)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#if FF_API_AVPICTURE
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_picture AVPicture
+ *
+ * Functions for working with AVPicture
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * Picture data structure.
+ *
+ * Up to four components can be stored into it, the last component is
+ * alpha.
+ * @deprecated use AVFrame or imgutils functions instead
+ */
+typedef struct AVPicture {
+    attribute_deprecated
+    uint8_t *data[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];    ///< pointers to the image data planes
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int linesize[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS];     ///< number of bytes per line
+} AVPicture;
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+#endif
+
+enum AVSubtitleType {
+    SUBTITLE_NONE,
+
+    SUBTITLE_BITMAP,                ///< A bitmap, pict will be set
+
+    /**
+     * Plain text, the text field must be set by the decoder and is
+     * authoritative. ass and pict fields may contain approximations.
+     */
+    SUBTITLE_TEXT,
+
+    /**
+     * Formatted text, the ass field must be set by the decoder and is
+     * authoritative. pict and text fields may contain approximations.
+     */
+    SUBTITLE_ASS,
+};
+
+#define AV_SUBTITLE_FLAG_FORCED 0x00000001
+
+typedef struct AVSubtitleRect {
+    int x;         ///< top left corner  of pict, undefined when pict is not set
+    int y;         ///< top left corner  of pict, undefined when pict is not set
+    int w;         ///< width            of pict, undefined when pict is not set
+    int h;         ///< height           of pict, undefined when pict is not set
+    int nb_colors; ///< number of colors in pict, undefined when pict is not set
+
+#if FF_API_AVPICTURE
+    /**
+     * @deprecated unused
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    AVPicture pict;
+#endif
+    /**
+     * data+linesize for the bitmap of this subtitle.
+     * Can be set for text/ass as well once they are rendered.
+     */
+    uint8_t *data[4];
+    int linesize[4];
+
+    enum AVSubtitleType type;
+
+    char *text;                     ///< 0 terminated plain UTF-8 text
+
+    /**
+     * 0 terminated ASS/SSA compatible event line.
+     * The presentation of this is unaffected by the other values in this
+     * struct.
+     */
+    char *ass;
+
+    int flags;
+} AVSubtitleRect;
+
+typedef struct AVSubtitle {
+    uint16_t format; /* 0 = graphics */
+    uint32_t start_display_time; /* relative to packet pts, in ms */
+    uint32_t end_display_time; /* relative to packet pts, in ms */
+    unsigned num_rects;
+    AVSubtitleRect **rects;
+    int64_t pts;    ///< Same as packet pts, in AV_TIME_BASE
+} AVSubtitle;
+
+/**
+ * This struct describes the properties of an encoded stream.
+ *
+ * sizeof(AVCodecParameters) is not a part of the public ABI, this struct must
+ * be allocated with avcodec_parameters_alloc() and freed with
+ * avcodec_parameters_free().
+ */
+typedef struct AVCodecParameters {
+    /**
+     * General type of the encoded data.
+     */
+    enum AVMediaType codec_type;
+    /**
+     * Specific type of the encoded data (the codec used).
+     */
+    enum AVCodecID   codec_id;
+    /**
+     * Additional information about the codec (corresponds to the AVI FOURCC).
+     */
+    uint32_t         codec_tag;
+
+    /**
+     * Extra binary data needed for initializing the decoder, codec-dependent.
+     *
+     * Must be allocated with av_malloc() and will be freed by
+     * avcodec_parameters_free(). The allocated size of extradata must be at
+     * least extradata_size + AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE, with the padding
+     * bytes zeroed.
+     */
+    uint8_t *extradata;
+    /**
+     * Size of the extradata content in bytes.
+     */
+    int      extradata_size;
+
+    /**
+     * - video: the pixel format, the value corresponds to enum AVPixelFormat.
+     * - audio: the sample format, the value corresponds to enum AVSampleFormat.
+     */
+    int format;
+
+    /**
+     * The average bitrate of the encoded data (in bits per second).
+     */
+    int64_t bit_rate;
+
+    /**
+     * The number of bits per sample in the codedwords.
+     *
+     * This is basically the bitrate per sample. It is mandatory for a bunch of
+     * formats to actually decode them. It's the number of bits for one sample in
+     * the actual coded bitstream.
+     *
+     * This could be for example 4 for ADPCM
+     * For PCM formats this matches bits_per_raw_sample
+     * Can be 0
+     */
+    int bits_per_coded_sample;
+
+    /**
+     * This is the number of valid bits in each output sample. If the
+     * sample format has more bits, the least significant bits are additional
+     * padding bits, which are always 0. Use right shifts to reduce the sample
+     * to its actual size. For example, audio formats with 24 bit samples will
+     * have bits_per_raw_sample set to 24, and format set to AV_SAMPLE_FMT_S32.
+     * To get the original sample use "(int32_t)sample >> 8"."
+     *
+     * For ADPCM this might be 12 or 16 or similar
+     * Can be 0
+     */
+    int bits_per_raw_sample;
+
+    /**
+     * Codec-specific bitstream restrictions that the stream conforms to.
+     */
+    int profile;
+    int level;
+
+    /**
+     * Video only. The dimensions of the video frame in pixels.
+     */
+    int width;
+    int height;
+
+    /**
+     * Video only. The aspect ratio (width / height) which a single pixel
+     * should have when displayed.
+     *
+     * When the aspect ratio is unknown / undefined, the numerator should be
+     * set to 0 (the denominator may have any value).
+     */
+    AVRational sample_aspect_ratio;
+
+    /**
+     * Video only. The order of the fields in interlaced video.
+     */
+    enum AVFieldOrder                  field_order;
+
+    /**
+     * Video only. Additional colorspace characteristics.
+     */
+    enum AVColorRange                  color_range;
+    enum AVColorPrimaries              color_primaries;
+    enum AVColorTransferCharacteristic color_trc;
+    enum AVColorSpace                  color_space;
+    enum AVChromaLocation              chroma_location;
+
+    /**
+     * Video only. Number of delayed frames.
+     */
+    int video_delay;
+
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The channel layout bitmask. May be 0 if the channel layout is
+     * unknown or unspecified, otherwise the number of bits set must be equal to
+     * the channels field.
+     */
+    uint64_t channel_layout;
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The number of audio channels.
+     */
+    int      channels;
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The number of audio samples per second.
+     */
+    int      sample_rate;
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The number of bytes per coded audio frame, required by some
+     * formats.
+     *
+     * Corresponds to nBlockAlign in WAVEFORMATEX.
+     */
+    int      block_align;
+    /**
+     * Audio only. Audio frame size, if known. Required by some formats to be static.
+     */
+    int      frame_size;
+
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The amount of padding (in samples) inserted by the encoder at
+     * the beginning of the audio. I.e. this number of leading decoded samples
+     * must be discarded by the caller to get the original audio without leading
+     * padding.
+     */
+    int initial_padding;
+    /**
+     * Audio only. The amount of padding (in samples) appended by the encoder to
+     * the end of the audio. I.e. this number of decoded samples must be
+     * discarded by the caller from the end of the stream to get the original
+     * audio without any trailing padding.
+     */
+    int trailing_padding;
+    /**
+     * Audio only. Number of samples to skip after a discontinuity.
+     */
+    int seek_preroll;
+} AVCodecParameters;
+
+/**
+ * Iterate over all registered codecs.
+ *
+ * @param opaque a pointer where libavcodec will store the iteration state. Must
+ *               point to NULL to start the iteration.
+ *
+ * @return the next registered codec or NULL when the iteration is
+ *         finished
+ */
+const AVCodec *av_codec_iterate(void **opaque);
+
+#if FF_API_NEXT
+/**
+ * If c is NULL, returns the first registered codec,
+ * if c is non-NULL, returns the next registered codec after c,
+ * or NULL if c is the last one.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+AVCodec *av_codec_next(const AVCodec *c);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Return the LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_INT constant.
+ */
+unsigned avcodec_version(void);
+
+/**
+ * Return the libavcodec build-time configuration.
+ */
+const char *avcodec_configuration(void);
+
+/**
+ * Return the libavcodec license.
+ */
+const char *avcodec_license(void);
+
+#if FF_API_NEXT
+/**
+ * Register the codec codec and initialize libavcodec.
+ *
+ * @warning either this function or avcodec_register_all() must be called
+ * before any other libavcodec functions.
+ *
+ * @see avcodec_register_all()
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void avcodec_register(AVCodec *codec);
+
+/**
+ * Register all the codecs, parsers and bitstream filters which were enabled at
+ * configuration time. If you do not call this function you can select exactly
+ * which formats you want to support, by using the individual registration
+ * functions.
+ *
+ * @see avcodec_register
+ * @see av_register_codec_parser
+ * @see av_register_bitstream_filter
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void avcodec_register_all(void);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Allocate an AVCodecContext and set its fields to default values. The
+ * resulting struct should be freed with avcodec_free_context().
+ *
+ * @param codec if non-NULL, allocate private data and initialize defaults
+ *              for the given codec. It is illegal to then call avcodec_open2()
+ *              with a different codec.
+ *              If NULL, then the codec-specific defaults won't be initialized,
+ *              which may result in suboptimal default settings (this is
+ *              important mainly for encoders, e.g. libx264).
+ *
+ * @return An AVCodecContext filled with default values or NULL on failure.
+ */
+AVCodecContext *avcodec_alloc_context3(const AVCodec *codec);
+
+/**
+ * Free the codec context and everything associated with it and write NULL to
+ * the provided pointer.
+ */
+void avcodec_free_context(AVCodecContext **avctx);
+
+#if FF_API_GET_CONTEXT_DEFAULTS
+/**
+ * @deprecated This function should not be used, as closing and opening a codec
+ * context multiple time is not supported. A new codec context should be
+ * allocated for each new use.
+ */
+int avcodec_get_context_defaults3(AVCodecContext *s, const AVCodec *codec);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Get the AVClass for AVCodecContext. It can be used in combination with
+ * AV_OPT_SEARCH_FAKE_OBJ for examining options.
+ *
+ * @see av_opt_find().
+ */
+const AVClass *avcodec_get_class(void);
+
+#if FF_API_COPY_CONTEXT
+/**
+ * Get the AVClass for AVFrame. It can be used in combination with
+ * AV_OPT_SEARCH_FAKE_OBJ for examining options.
+ *
+ * @see av_opt_find().
+ */
+const AVClass *avcodec_get_frame_class(void);
+
+/**
+ * Get the AVClass for AVSubtitleRect. It can be used in combination with
+ * AV_OPT_SEARCH_FAKE_OBJ for examining options.
+ *
+ * @see av_opt_find().
+ */
+const AVClass *avcodec_get_subtitle_rect_class(void);
+
+/**
+ * Copy the settings of the source AVCodecContext into the destination
+ * AVCodecContext. The resulting destination codec context will be
+ * unopened, i.e. you are required to call avcodec_open2() before you
+ * can use this AVCodecContext to decode/encode video/audio data.
+ *
+ * @param dest target codec context, should be initialized with
+ *             avcodec_alloc_context3(NULL), but otherwise uninitialized
+ * @param src source codec context
+ * @return AVERROR() on error (e.g. memory allocation error), 0 on success
+ *
+ * @deprecated The semantics of this function are ill-defined and it should not
+ * be used. If you need to transfer the stream parameters from one codec context
+ * to another, use an intermediate AVCodecParameters instance and the
+ * avcodec_parameters_from_context() / avcodec_parameters_to_context()
+ * functions.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avcodec_copy_context(AVCodecContext *dest, const AVCodecContext *src);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Allocate a new AVCodecParameters and set its fields to default values
+ * (unknown/invalid/0). The returned struct must be freed with
+ * avcodec_parameters_free().
+ */
+AVCodecParameters *avcodec_parameters_alloc(void);
+
+/**
+ * Free an AVCodecParameters instance and everything associated with it and
+ * write NULL to the supplied pointer.
+ */
+void avcodec_parameters_free(AVCodecParameters **par);
+
+/**
+ * Copy the contents of src to dst. Any allocated fields in dst are freed and
+ * replaced with newly allocated duplicates of the corresponding fields in src.
+ *
+ * @return >= 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
+ */
+int avcodec_parameters_copy(AVCodecParameters *dst, const AVCodecParameters *src);
+
+/**
+ * Fill the parameters struct based on the values from the supplied codec
+ * context. Any allocated fields in par are freed and replaced with duplicates
+ * of the corresponding fields in codec.
+ *
+ * @return >= 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
+ */
+int avcodec_parameters_from_context(AVCodecParameters *par,
+                                    const AVCodecContext *codec);
+
+/**
+ * Fill the codec context based on the values from the supplied codec
+ * parameters. Any allocated fields in codec that have a corresponding field in
+ * par are freed and replaced with duplicates of the corresponding field in par.
+ * Fields in codec that do not have a counterpart in par are not touched.
+ *
+ * @return >= 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
+ */
+int avcodec_parameters_to_context(AVCodecContext *codec,
+                                  const AVCodecParameters *par);
+
+/**
+ * Initialize the AVCodecContext to use the given AVCodec. Prior to using this
+ * function the context has to be allocated with avcodec_alloc_context3().
+ *
+ * The functions avcodec_find_decoder_by_name(), avcodec_find_encoder_by_name(),
+ * avcodec_find_decoder() and avcodec_find_encoder() provide an easy way for
+ * retrieving a codec.
+ *
+ * @warning This function is not thread safe!
+ *
+ * @note Always call this function before using decoding routines (such as
+ * @ref avcodec_receive_frame()).
+ *
+ * @code
+ * avcodec_register_all();
+ * av_dict_set(&opts, "b", "2.5M", 0);
+ * codec = avcodec_find_decoder(AV_CODEC_ID_H264);
+ * if (!codec)
+ *     exit(1);
+ *
+ * context = avcodec_alloc_context3(codec);
+ *
+ * if (avcodec_open2(context, codec, opts) < 0)
+ *     exit(1);
+ * @endcode
+ *
+ * @param avctx The context to initialize.
+ * @param codec The codec to open this context for. If a non-NULL codec has been
+ *              previously passed to avcodec_alloc_context3() or
+ *              for this context, then this parameter MUST be either NULL or
+ *              equal to the previously passed codec.
+ * @param options A dictionary filled with AVCodecContext and codec-private options.
+ *                On return this object will be filled with options that were not found.
+ *
+ * @return zero on success, a negative value on error
+ * @see avcodec_alloc_context3(), avcodec_find_decoder(), avcodec_find_encoder(),
+ *      av_dict_set(), av_opt_find().
+ */
+int avcodec_open2(AVCodecContext *avctx, const AVCodec *codec, AVDictionary **options);
+
+/**
+ * Close a given AVCodecContext and free all the data associated with it
+ * (but not the AVCodecContext itself).
+ *
+ * Calling this function on an AVCodecContext that hasn't been opened will free
+ * the codec-specific data allocated in avcodec_alloc_context3() with a non-NULL
+ * codec. Subsequent calls will do nothing.
+ *
+ * @note Do not use this function. Use avcodec_free_context() to destroy a
+ * codec context (either open or closed). Opening and closing a codec context
+ * multiple times is not supported anymore -- use multiple codec contexts
+ * instead.
+ */
+int avcodec_close(AVCodecContext *avctx);
+
+/**
+ * Free all allocated data in the given subtitle struct.
+ *
+ * @param sub AVSubtitle to free.
+ */
+void avsubtitle_free(AVSubtitle *sub);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavc_packet
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * Allocate an AVPacket and set its fields to default values.  The resulting
+ * struct must be freed using av_packet_free().
+ *
+ * @return An AVPacket filled with default values or NULL on failure.
+ *
+ * @note this only allocates the AVPacket itself, not the data buffers. Those
+ * must be allocated through other means such as av_new_packet.
+ *
+ * @see av_new_packet
+ */
+AVPacket *av_packet_alloc(void);
+
+/**
+ * Create a new packet that references the same data as src.
+ *
+ * This is a shortcut for av_packet_alloc()+av_packet_ref().
+ *
+ * @return newly created AVPacket on success, NULL on error.
+ *
+ * @see av_packet_alloc
+ * @see av_packet_ref
+ */
+AVPacket *av_packet_clone(const AVPacket *src);
+
+/**
+ * Free the packet, if the packet is reference counted, it will be
+ * unreferenced first.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet to be freed. The pointer will be set to NULL.
+ * @note passing NULL is a no-op.
+ */
+void av_packet_free(AVPacket **pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Initialize optional fields of a packet with default values.
+ *
+ * Note, this does not touch the data and size members, which have to be
+ * initialized separately.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ */
+void av_init_packet(AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Allocate the payload of a packet and initialize its fields with
+ * default values.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param size wanted payload size
+ * @return 0 if OK, AVERROR_xxx otherwise
+ */
+int av_new_packet(AVPacket *pkt, int size);
+
+/**
+ * Reduce packet size, correctly zeroing padding
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param size new size
+ */
+void av_shrink_packet(AVPacket *pkt, int size);
+
+/**
+ * Increase packet size, correctly zeroing padding
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param grow_by number of bytes by which to increase the size of the packet
+ */
+int av_grow_packet(AVPacket *pkt, int grow_by);
+
+/**
+ * Initialize a reference-counted packet from av_malloc()ed data.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet to be initialized. This function will set the data, size,
+ *        buf and destruct fields, all others are left untouched.
+ * @param data Data allocated by av_malloc() to be used as packet data. If this
+ *        function returns successfully, the data is owned by the underlying AVBuffer.
+ *        The caller may not access the data through other means.
+ * @param size size of data in bytes, without the padding. I.e. the full buffer
+ *        size is assumed to be size + AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error
+ */
+int av_packet_from_data(AVPacket *pkt, uint8_t *data, int size);
+
+#if FF_API_AVPACKET_OLD_API
+/**
+ * @warning This is a hack - the packet memory allocation stuff is broken. The
+ * packet is allocated if it was not really allocated.
+ *
+ * @deprecated Use av_packet_ref or av_packet_make_refcounted
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_dup_packet(AVPacket *pkt);
+/**
+ * Copy packet, including contents
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, negative AVERROR on fail
+ *
+ * @deprecated Use av_packet_ref
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_copy_packet(AVPacket *dst, const AVPacket *src);
+
+/**
+ * Copy packet side data
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, negative AVERROR on fail
+ *
+ * @deprecated Use av_packet_copy_props
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_copy_packet_side_data(AVPacket *dst, const AVPacket *src);
+
+/**
+ * Free a packet.
+ *
+ * @deprecated Use av_packet_unref
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet to free
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_free_packet(AVPacket *pkt);
+#endif
+/**
+ * Allocate new information of a packet.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param type side information type
+ * @param size side information size
+ * @return pointer to fresh allocated data or NULL otherwise
+ */
+uint8_t* av_packet_new_side_data(AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
+                                 int size);
+
+/**
+ * Wrap an existing array as a packet side data.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param type side information type
+ * @param data the side data array. It must be allocated with the av_malloc()
+ *             family of functions. The ownership of the data is transferred to
+ *             pkt.
+ * @param size side information size
+ * @return a non-negative number on success, a negative AVERROR code on
+ *         failure. On failure, the packet is unchanged and the data remains
+ *         owned by the caller.
+ */
+int av_packet_add_side_data(AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
+                            uint8_t *data, size_t size);
+
+/**
+ * Shrink the already allocated side data buffer
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param type side information type
+ * @param size new side information size
+ * @return 0 on success, < 0 on failure
+ */
+int av_packet_shrink_side_data(AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
+                               int size);
+
+/**
+ * Get side information from packet.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ * @param type desired side information type
+ * @param size pointer for side information size to store (optional)
+ * @return pointer to data if present or NULL otherwise
+ */
+uint8_t* av_packet_get_side_data(const AVPacket *pkt, enum AVPacketSideDataType type,
+                                 int *size);
+
+#if FF_API_MERGE_SD_API
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_packet_merge_side_data(AVPacket *pkt);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_packet_split_side_data(AVPacket *pkt);
+#endif
+
+const char *av_packet_side_data_name(enum AVPacketSideDataType type);
+
+/**
+ * Pack a dictionary for use in side_data.
+ *
+ * @param dict The dictionary to pack.
+ * @param size pointer to store the size of the returned data
+ * @return pointer to data if successful, NULL otherwise
+ */
+uint8_t *av_packet_pack_dictionary(AVDictionary *dict, int *size);
+/**
+ * Unpack a dictionary from side_data.
+ *
+ * @param data data from side_data
+ * @param size size of the data
+ * @param dict the metadata storage dictionary
+ * @return 0 on success, < 0 on failure
+ */
+int av_packet_unpack_dictionary(const uint8_t *data, int size, AVDictionary **dict);
+
+
+/**
+ * Convenience function to free all the side data stored.
+ * All the other fields stay untouched.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet
+ */
+void av_packet_free_side_data(AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Setup a new reference to the data described by a given packet
+ *
+ * If src is reference-counted, setup dst as a new reference to the
+ * buffer in src. Otherwise allocate a new buffer in dst and copy the
+ * data from src into it.
+ *
+ * All the other fields are copied from src.
+ *
+ * @see av_packet_unref
+ *
+ * @param dst Destination packet
+ * @param src Source packet
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error.
+ */
+int av_packet_ref(AVPacket *dst, const AVPacket *src);
+
+/**
+ * Wipe the packet.
+ *
+ * Unreference the buffer referenced by the packet and reset the
+ * remaining packet fields to their default values.
+ *
+ * @param pkt The packet to be unreferenced.
+ */
+void av_packet_unref(AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Move every field in src to dst and reset src.
+ *
+ * @see av_packet_unref
+ *
+ * @param src Source packet, will be reset
+ * @param dst Destination packet
+ */
+void av_packet_move_ref(AVPacket *dst, AVPacket *src);
+
+/**
+ * Copy only "properties" fields from src to dst.
+ *
+ * Properties for the purpose of this function are all the fields
+ * beside those related to the packet data (buf, data, size)
+ *
+ * @param dst Destination packet
+ * @param src Source packet
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success AVERROR on failure.
+ */
+int av_packet_copy_props(AVPacket *dst, const AVPacket *src);
+
+/**
+ * Ensure the data described by a given packet is reference counted.
+ *
+ * @note This function does not ensure that the reference will be writable.
+ *       Use av_packet_make_writable instead for that purpose.
+ *
+ * @see av_packet_ref
+ * @see av_packet_make_writable
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet whose data should be made reference counted.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error. On failure, the
+ *         packet is unchanged.
+ */
+int av_packet_make_refcounted(AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Create a writable reference for the data described by a given packet,
+ * avoiding data copy if possible.
+ *
+ * @param pkt Packet whose data should be made writable.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on failure. On failure, the
+ *         packet is unchanged.
+ */
+int av_packet_make_writable(AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Convert valid timing fields (timestamps / durations) in a packet from one
+ * timebase to another. Timestamps with unknown values (AV_NOPTS_VALUE) will be
+ * ignored.
+ *
+ * @param pkt packet on which the conversion will be performed
+ * @param tb_src source timebase, in which the timing fields in pkt are
+ *               expressed
+ * @param tb_dst destination timebase, to which the timing fields will be
+ *               converted
+ */
+void av_packet_rescale_ts(AVPacket *pkt, AVRational tb_src, AVRational tb_dst);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavc_decoding
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * Find a registered decoder with a matching codec ID.
+ *
+ * @param id AVCodecID of the requested decoder
+ * @return A decoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
+ */
+AVCodec *avcodec_find_decoder(enum AVCodecID id);
+
+/**
+ * Find a registered decoder with the specified name.
+ *
+ * @param name name of the requested decoder
+ * @return A decoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
+ */
+AVCodec *avcodec_find_decoder_by_name(const char *name);
+
+/**
+ * The default callback for AVCodecContext.get_buffer2(). It is made public so
+ * it can be called by custom get_buffer2() implementations for decoders without
+ * AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1 set.
+ */
+int avcodec_default_get_buffer2(AVCodecContext *s, AVFrame *frame, int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Modify width and height values so that they will result in a memory
+ * buffer that is acceptable for the codec if you do not use any horizontal
+ * padding.
+ *
+ * May only be used if a codec with AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1 has been opened.
+ */
+void avcodec_align_dimensions(AVCodecContext *s, int *width, int *height);
+
+/**
+ * Modify width and height values so that they will result in a memory
+ * buffer that is acceptable for the codec if you also ensure that all
+ * line sizes are a multiple of the respective linesize_align[i].
+ *
+ * May only be used if a codec with AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1 has been opened.
+ */
+void avcodec_align_dimensions2(AVCodecContext *s, int *width, int *height,
+                               int linesize_align[AV_NUM_DATA_POINTERS]);
+
+/**
+ * Converts AVChromaLocation to swscale x/y chroma position.
+ *
+ * The positions represent the chroma (0,0) position in a coordinates system
+ * with luma (0,0) representing the origin and luma(1,1) representing 256,256
+ *
+ * @param xpos  horizontal chroma sample position
+ * @param ypos  vertical   chroma sample position
+ */
+int avcodec_enum_to_chroma_pos(int *xpos, int *ypos, enum AVChromaLocation pos);
+
+/**
+ * Converts swscale x/y chroma position to AVChromaLocation.
+ *
+ * The positions represent the chroma (0,0) position in a coordinates system
+ * with luma (0,0) representing the origin and luma(1,1) representing 256,256
+ *
+ * @param xpos  horizontal chroma sample position
+ * @param ypos  vertical   chroma sample position
+ */
+enum AVChromaLocation avcodec_chroma_pos_to_enum(int xpos, int ypos);
+
+/**
+ * Decode the audio frame of size avpkt->size from avpkt->data into frame.
+ *
+ * Some decoders may support multiple frames in a single AVPacket. Such
+ * decoders would then just decode the first frame and the return value would be
+ * less than the packet size. In this case, avcodec_decode_audio4 has to be
+ * called again with an AVPacket containing the remaining data in order to
+ * decode the second frame, etc...  Even if no frames are returned, the packet
+ * needs to be fed to the decoder with remaining data until it is completely
+ * consumed or an error occurs.
+ *
+ * Some decoders (those marked with AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY) have a delay between input
+ * and output. This means that for some packets they will not immediately
+ * produce decoded output and need to be flushed at the end of decoding to get
+ * all the decoded data. Flushing is done by calling this function with packets
+ * with avpkt->data set to NULL and avpkt->size set to 0 until it stops
+ * returning samples. It is safe to flush even those decoders that are not
+ * marked with AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY, then no samples will be returned.
+ *
+ * @warning The input buffer, avpkt->data must be AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE
+ *          larger than the actual read bytes because some optimized bitstream
+ *          readers read 32 or 64 bits at once and could read over the end.
+ *
+ * @note The AVCodecContext MUST have been opened with @ref avcodec_open2()
+ * before packets may be fed to the decoder.
+ *
+ * @param      avctx the codec context
+ * @param[out] frame The AVFrame in which to store decoded audio samples.
+ *                   The decoder will allocate a buffer for the decoded frame by
+ *                   calling the AVCodecContext.get_buffer2() callback.
+ *                   When AVCodecContext.refcounted_frames is set to 1, the frame is
+ *                   reference counted and the returned reference belongs to the
+ *                   caller. The caller must release the frame using av_frame_unref()
+ *                   when the frame is no longer needed. The caller may safely write
+ *                   to the frame if av_frame_is_writable() returns 1.
+ *                   When AVCodecContext.refcounted_frames is set to 0, the returned
+ *                   reference belongs to the decoder and is valid only until the
+ *                   next call to this function or until closing or flushing the
+ *                   decoder. The caller may not write to it.
+ * @param[out] got_frame_ptr Zero if no frame could be decoded, otherwise it is
+ *                           non-zero. Note that this field being set to zero
+ *                           does not mean that an error has occurred. For
+ *                           decoders with AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY set, no given decode
+ *                           call is guaranteed to produce a frame.
+ * @param[in]  avpkt The input AVPacket containing the input buffer.
+ *                   At least avpkt->data and avpkt->size should be set. Some
+ *                   decoders might also require additional fields to be set.
+ * @return A negative error code is returned if an error occurred during
+ *         decoding, otherwise the number of bytes consumed from the input
+ *         AVPacket is returned.
+ *
+* @deprecated Use avcodec_send_packet() and avcodec_receive_frame().
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avcodec_decode_audio4(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVFrame *frame,
+                          int *got_frame_ptr, const AVPacket *avpkt);
+
+/**
+ * Decode the video frame of size avpkt->size from avpkt->data into picture.
+ * Some decoders may support multiple frames in a single AVPacket, such
+ * decoders would then just decode the first frame.
+ *
+ * @warning The input buffer must be AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE larger than
+ * the actual read bytes because some optimized bitstream readers read 32 or 64
+ * bits at once and could read over the end.
+ *
+ * @warning The end of the input buffer buf should be set to 0 to ensure that
+ * no overreading happens for damaged MPEG streams.
+ *
+ * @note Codecs which have the AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY capability set have a delay
+ * between input and output, these need to be fed with avpkt->data=NULL,
+ * avpkt->size=0 at the end to return the remaining frames.
+ *
+ * @note The AVCodecContext MUST have been opened with @ref avcodec_open2()
+ * before packets may be fed to the decoder.
+ *
+ * @param avctx the codec context
+ * @param[out] picture The AVFrame in which the decoded video frame will be stored.
+ *             Use av_frame_alloc() to get an AVFrame. The codec will
+ *             allocate memory for the actual bitmap by calling the
+ *             AVCodecContext.get_buffer2() callback.
+ *             When AVCodecContext.refcounted_frames is set to 1, the frame is
+ *             reference counted and the returned reference belongs to the
+ *             caller. The caller must release the frame using av_frame_unref()
+ *             when the frame is no longer needed. The caller may safely write
+ *             to the frame if av_frame_is_writable() returns 1.
+ *             When AVCodecContext.refcounted_frames is set to 0, the returned
+ *             reference belongs to the decoder and is valid only until the
+ *             next call to this function or until closing or flushing the
+ *             decoder. The caller may not write to it.
+ *
+ * @param[in] avpkt The input AVPacket containing the input buffer.
+ *            You can create such packet with av_init_packet() and by then setting
+ *            data and size, some decoders might in addition need other fields like
+ *            flags&AV_PKT_FLAG_KEY. All decoders are designed to use the least
+ *            fields possible.
+ * @param[in,out] got_picture_ptr Zero if no frame could be decompressed, otherwise, it is nonzero.
+ * @return On error a negative value is returned, otherwise the number of bytes
+ * used or zero if no frame could be decompressed.
+ *
+ * @deprecated Use avcodec_send_packet() and avcodec_receive_frame().
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avcodec_decode_video2(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVFrame *picture,
+                         int *got_picture_ptr,
+                         const AVPacket *avpkt);
+
+/**
+ * Decode a subtitle message.
+ * Return a negative value on error, otherwise return the number of bytes used.
+ * If no subtitle could be decompressed, got_sub_ptr is zero.
+ * Otherwise, the subtitle is stored in *sub.
+ * Note that AV_CODEC_CAP_DR1 is not available for subtitle codecs. This is for
+ * simplicity, because the performance difference is expect to be negligible
+ * and reusing a get_buffer written for video codecs would probably perform badly
+ * due to a potentially very different allocation pattern.
+ *
+ * Some decoders (those marked with AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY) have a delay between input
+ * and output. This means that for some packets they will not immediately
+ * produce decoded output and need to be flushed at the end of decoding to get
+ * all the decoded data. Flushing is done by calling this function with packets
+ * with avpkt->data set to NULL and avpkt->size set to 0 until it stops
+ * returning subtitles. It is safe to flush even those decoders that are not
+ * marked with AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY, then no subtitles will be returned.
+ *
+ * @note The AVCodecContext MUST have been opened with @ref avcodec_open2()
+ * before packets may be fed to the decoder.
+ *
+ * @param avctx the codec context
+ * @param[out] sub The Preallocated AVSubtitle in which the decoded subtitle will be stored,
+ *                 must be freed with avsubtitle_free if *got_sub_ptr is set.
+ * @param[in,out] got_sub_ptr Zero if no subtitle could be decompressed, otherwise, it is nonzero.
+ * @param[in] avpkt The input AVPacket containing the input buffer.
+ */
+int avcodec_decode_subtitle2(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVSubtitle *sub,
+                            int *got_sub_ptr,
+                            AVPacket *avpkt);
+
+/**
+ * Supply raw packet data as input to a decoder.
+ *
+ * Internally, this call will copy relevant AVCodecContext fields, which can
+ * influence decoding per-packet, and apply them when the packet is actually
+ * decoded. (For example AVCodecContext.skip_frame, which might direct the
+ * decoder to drop the frame contained by the packet sent with this function.)
+ *
+ * @warning The input buffer, avpkt->data must be AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE
+ *          larger than the actual read bytes because some optimized bitstream
+ *          readers read 32 or 64 bits at once and could read over the end.
+ *
+ * @warning Do not mix this API with the legacy API (like avcodec_decode_video2())
+ *          on the same AVCodecContext. It will return unexpected results now
+ *          or in future libavcodec versions.
+ *
+ * @note The AVCodecContext MUST have been opened with @ref avcodec_open2()
+ *       before packets may be fed to the decoder.
+ *
+ * @param avctx codec context
+ * @param[in] avpkt The input AVPacket. Usually, this will be a single video
+ *                  frame, or several complete audio frames.
+ *                  Ownership of the packet remains with the caller, and the
+ *                  decoder will not write to the packet. The decoder may create
+ *                  a reference to the packet data (or copy it if the packet is
+ *                  not reference-counted).
+ *                  Unlike with older APIs, the packet is always fully consumed,
+ *                  and if it contains multiple frames (e.g. some audio codecs),
+ *                  will require you to call avcodec_receive_frame() multiple
+ *                  times afterwards before you can send a new packet.
+ *                  It can be NULL (or an AVPacket with data set to NULL and
+ *                  size set to 0); in this case, it is considered a flush
+ *                  packet, which signals the end of the stream. Sending the
+ *                  first flush packet will return success. Subsequent ones are
+ *                  unnecessary and will return AVERROR_EOF. If the decoder
+ *                  still has frames buffered, it will return them after sending
+ *                  a flush packet.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, otherwise negative error code:
+ *      AVERROR(EAGAIN):   input is not accepted in the current state - user
+ *                         must read output with avcodec_receive_frame() (once
+ *                         all output is read, the packet should be resent, and
+ *                         the call will not fail with EAGAIN).
+ *      AVERROR_EOF:       the decoder has been flushed, and no new packets can
+ *                         be sent to it (also returned if more than 1 flush
+ *                         packet is sent)
+ *      AVERROR(EINVAL):   codec not opened, it is an encoder, or requires flush
+ *      AVERROR(ENOMEM):   failed to add packet to internal queue, or similar
+ *      other errors: legitimate decoding errors
+ */
+int avcodec_send_packet(AVCodecContext *avctx, const AVPacket *avpkt);
+
+/**
+ * Return decoded output data from a decoder.
+ *
+ * @param avctx codec context
+ * @param frame This will be set to a reference-counted video or audio
+ *              frame (depending on the decoder type) allocated by the
+ *              decoder. Note that the function will always call
+ *              av_frame_unref(frame) before doing anything else.
+ *
+ * @return
+ *      0:                 success, a frame was returned
+ *      AVERROR(EAGAIN):   output is not available in this state - user must try
+ *                         to send new input
+ *      AVERROR_EOF:       the decoder has been fully flushed, and there will be
+ *                         no more output frames
+ *      AVERROR(EINVAL):   codec not opened, or it is an encoder
+ *      other negative values: legitimate decoding errors
+ */
+int avcodec_receive_frame(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVFrame *frame);
+
+/**
+ * Supply a raw video or audio frame to the encoder. Use avcodec_receive_packet()
+ * to retrieve buffered output packets.
+ *
+ * @param avctx     codec context
+ * @param[in] frame AVFrame containing the raw audio or video frame to be encoded.
+ *                  Ownership of the frame remains with the caller, and the
+ *                  encoder will not write to the frame. The encoder may create
+ *                  a reference to the frame data (or copy it if the frame is
+ *                  not reference-counted).
+ *                  It can be NULL, in which case it is considered a flush
+ *                  packet.  This signals the end of the stream. If the encoder
+ *                  still has packets buffered, it will return them after this
+ *                  call. Once flushing mode has been entered, additional flush
+ *                  packets are ignored, and sending frames will return
+ *                  AVERROR_EOF.
+ *
+ *                  For audio:
+ *                  If AV_CODEC_CAP_VARIABLE_FRAME_SIZE is set, then each frame
+ *                  can have any number of samples.
+ *                  If it is not set, frame->nb_samples must be equal to
+ *                  avctx->frame_size for all frames except the last.
+ *                  The final frame may be smaller than avctx->frame_size.
+ * @return 0 on success, otherwise negative error code:
+ *      AVERROR(EAGAIN):   input is not accepted in the current state - user
+ *                         must read output with avcodec_receive_packet() (once
+ *                         all output is read, the packet should be resent, and
+ *                         the call will not fail with EAGAIN).
+ *      AVERROR_EOF:       the encoder has been flushed, and no new frames can
+ *                         be sent to it
+ *      AVERROR(EINVAL):   codec not opened, refcounted_frames not set, it is a
+ *                         decoder, or requires flush
+ *      AVERROR(ENOMEM):   failed to add packet to internal queue, or similar
+ *      other errors: legitimate decoding errors
+ */
+int avcodec_send_frame(AVCodecContext *avctx, const AVFrame *frame);
+
+/**
+ * Read encoded data from the encoder.
+ *
+ * @param avctx codec context
+ * @param avpkt This will be set to a reference-counted packet allocated by the
+ *              encoder. Note that the function will always call
+ *              av_frame_unref(frame) before doing anything else.
+ * @return 0 on success, otherwise negative error code:
+ *      AVERROR(EAGAIN):   output is not available in the current state - user
+ *                         must try to send input
+ *      AVERROR_EOF:       the encoder has been fully flushed, and there will be
+ *                         no more output packets
+ *      AVERROR(EINVAL):   codec not opened, or it is an encoder
+ *      other errors: legitimate decoding errors
+ */
+int avcodec_receive_packet(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVPacket *avpkt);
+
+/**
+ * Create and return a AVHWFramesContext with values adequate for hardware
+ * decoding. This is meant to get called from the get_format callback, and is
+ * a helper for preparing a AVHWFramesContext for AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx.
+ * This API is for decoding with certain hardware acceleration modes/APIs only.
+ *
+ * The returned AVHWFramesContext is not initialized. The caller must do this
+ * with av_hwframe_ctx_init().
+ *
+ * Calling this function is not a requirement, but makes it simpler to avoid
+ * codec or hardware API specific details when manually allocating frames.
+ *
+ * Alternatively to this, an API user can set AVCodecContext.hw_device_ctx,
+ * which sets up AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx fully automatically, and makes
+ * it unnecessary to call this function or having to care about
+ * AVHWFramesContext initialization at all.
+ *
+ * There are a number of requirements for calling this function:
+ *
+ * - It must be called from get_format with the same avctx parameter that was
+ *   passed to get_format. Calling it outside of get_format is not allowed, and
+ *   can trigger undefined behavior.
+ * - The function is not always supported (see description of return values).
+ *   Even if this function returns successfully, hwaccel initialization could
+ *   fail later. (The degree to which implementations check whether the stream
+ *   is actually supported varies. Some do this check only after the user's
+ *   get_format callback returns.)
+ * - The hw_pix_fmt must be one of the choices suggested by get_format. If the
+ *   user decides to use a AVHWFramesContext prepared with this API function,
+ *   the user must return the same hw_pix_fmt from get_format.
+ * - The device_ref passed to this function must support the given hw_pix_fmt.
+ * - After calling this API function, it is the user's responsibility to
+ *   initialize the AVHWFramesContext (returned by the out_frames_ref parameter),
+ *   and to set AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx to it. If done, this must be done
+ *   before returning from get_format (this is implied by the normal
+ *   AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx API rules).
+ * - The AVHWFramesContext parameters may change every time time get_format is
+ *   called. Also, AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx is reset before get_format. So
+ *   you are inherently required to go through this process again on every
+ *   get_format call.
+ * - It is perfectly possible to call this function without actually using
+ *   the resulting AVHWFramesContext. One use-case might be trying to reuse a
+ *   previously initialized AVHWFramesContext, and calling this API function
+ *   only to test whether the required frame parameters have changed.
+ * - Fields that use dynamically allocated values of any kind must not be set
+ *   by the user unless setting them is explicitly allowed by the documentation.
+ *   If the user sets AVHWFramesContext.free and AVHWFramesContext.user_opaque,
+ *   the new free callback must call the potentially set previous free callback.
+ *   This API call may set any dynamically allocated fields, including the free
+ *   callback.
+ *
+ * The function will set at least the following fields on AVHWFramesContext
+ * (potentially more, depending on hwaccel API):
+ *
+ * - All fields set by av_hwframe_ctx_alloc().
+ * - Set the format field to hw_pix_fmt.
+ * - Set the sw_format field to the most suited and most versatile format. (An
+ *   implication is that this will prefer generic formats over opaque formats
+ *   with arbitrary restrictions, if possible.)
+ * - Set the width/height fields to the coded frame size, rounded up to the
+ *   API-specific minimum alignment.
+ * - Only _if_ the hwaccel requires a pre-allocated pool: set the initial_pool_size
+ *   field to the number of maximum reference surfaces possible with the codec,
+ *   plus 1 surface for the user to work (meaning the user can safely reference
+ *   at most 1 decoded surface at a time), plus additional buffering introduced
+ *   by frame threading. If the hwaccel does not require pre-allocation, the
+ *   field is left to 0, and the decoder will allocate new surfaces on demand
+ *   during decoding.
+ * - Possibly AVHWFramesContext.hwctx fields, depending on the underlying
+ *   hardware API.
+ *
+ * Essentially, out_frames_ref returns the same as av_hwframe_ctx_alloc(), but
+ * with basic frame parameters set.
+ *
+ * The function is stateless, and does not change the AVCodecContext or the
+ * device_ref AVHWDeviceContext.
+ *
+ * @param avctx The context which is currently calling get_format, and which
+ *              implicitly contains all state needed for filling the returned
+ *              AVHWFramesContext properly.
+ * @param device_ref A reference to the AVHWDeviceContext describing the device
+ *                   which will be used by the hardware decoder.
+ * @param hw_pix_fmt The hwaccel format you are going to return from get_format.
+ * @param out_frames_ref On success, set to a reference to an _uninitialized_
+ *                       AVHWFramesContext, created from the given device_ref.
+ *                       Fields will be set to values required for decoding.
+ *                       Not changed if an error is returned.
+ * @return zero on success, a negative value on error. The following error codes
+ *         have special semantics:
+ *      AVERROR(ENOENT): the decoder does not support this functionality. Setup
+ *                       is always manual, or it is a decoder which does not
+ *                       support setting AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx at all,
+ *                       or it is a software format.
+ *      AVERROR(EINVAL): it is known that hardware decoding is not supported for
+ *                       this configuration, or the device_ref is not supported
+ *                       for the hwaccel referenced by hw_pix_fmt.
+ */
+int avcodec_get_hw_frames_parameters(AVCodecContext *avctx,
+                                     AVBufferRef *device_ref,
+                                     enum AVPixelFormat hw_pix_fmt,
+                                     AVBufferRef **out_frames_ref);
+
+
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_parsing Frame parsing
+ * @{
+ */
+
+enum AVPictureStructure {
+    AV_PICTURE_STRUCTURE_UNKNOWN,      //< unknown
+    AV_PICTURE_STRUCTURE_TOP_FIELD,    //< coded as top field
+    AV_PICTURE_STRUCTURE_BOTTOM_FIELD, //< coded as bottom field
+    AV_PICTURE_STRUCTURE_FRAME,        //< coded as frame
+};
+
+typedef struct AVCodecParserContext {
+    void *priv_data;
+    struct AVCodecParser *parser;
+    int64_t frame_offset; /* offset of the current frame */
+    int64_t cur_offset; /* current offset
+                           (incremented by each av_parser_parse()) */
+    int64_t next_frame_offset; /* offset of the next frame */
+    /* video info */
+    int pict_type; /* XXX: Put it back in AVCodecContext. */
+    /**
+     * This field is used for proper frame duration computation in lavf.
+     * It signals, how much longer the frame duration of the current frame
+     * is compared to normal frame duration.
+     *
+     * frame_duration = (1 + repeat_pict) * time_base
+     *
+     * It is used by codecs like H.264 to display telecined material.
+     */
+    int repeat_pict; /* XXX: Put it back in AVCodecContext. */
+    int64_t pts;     /* pts of the current frame */
+    int64_t dts;     /* dts of the current frame */
+
+    /* private data */
+    int64_t last_pts;
+    int64_t last_dts;
+    int fetch_timestamp;
+
+#define AV_PARSER_PTS_NB 4
+    int cur_frame_start_index;
+    int64_t cur_frame_offset[AV_PARSER_PTS_NB];
+    int64_t cur_frame_pts[AV_PARSER_PTS_NB];
+    int64_t cur_frame_dts[AV_PARSER_PTS_NB];
+
+    int flags;
+#define PARSER_FLAG_COMPLETE_FRAMES           0x0001
+#define PARSER_FLAG_ONCE                      0x0002
+/// Set if the parser has a valid file offset
+#define PARSER_FLAG_FETCHED_OFFSET            0x0004
+#define PARSER_FLAG_USE_CODEC_TS              0x1000
+
+    int64_t offset;      ///< byte offset from starting packet start
+    int64_t cur_frame_end[AV_PARSER_PTS_NB];
+
+    /**
+     * Set by parser to 1 for key frames and 0 for non-key frames.
+     * It is initialized to -1, so if the parser doesn't set this flag,
+     * old-style fallback using AV_PICTURE_TYPE_I picture type as key frames
+     * will be used.
+     */
+    int key_frame;
+
+#if FF_API_CONVERGENCE_DURATION
+    /**
+     * @deprecated unused
+     */
+    attribute_deprecated
+    int64_t convergence_duration;
+#endif
+
+    // Timestamp generation support:
+    /**
+     * Synchronization point for start of timestamp generation.
+     *
+     * Set to >0 for sync point, 0 for no sync point and <0 for undefined
+     * (default).
+     *
+     * For example, this corresponds to presence of H.264 buffering period
+     * SEI message.
+     */
+    int dts_sync_point;
+
+    /**
+     * Offset of the current timestamp against last timestamp sync point in
+     * units of AVCodecContext.time_base.
+     *
+     * Set to INT_MIN when dts_sync_point unused. Otherwise, it must
+     * contain a valid timestamp offset.
+     *
+     * Note that the timestamp of sync point has usually a nonzero
+     * dts_ref_dts_delta, which refers to the previous sync point. Offset of
+     * the next frame after timestamp sync point will be usually 1.
+     *
+     * For example, this corresponds to H.264 cpb_removal_delay.
+     */
+    int dts_ref_dts_delta;
+
+    /**
+     * Presentation delay of current frame in units of AVCodecContext.time_base.
+     *
+     * Set to INT_MIN when dts_sync_point unused. Otherwise, it must
+     * contain valid non-negative timestamp delta (presentation time of a frame
+     * must not lie in the past).
+     *
+     * This delay represents the difference between decoding and presentation
+     * time of the frame.
+     *
+     * For example, this corresponds to H.264 dpb_output_delay.
+     */
+    int pts_dts_delta;
+
+    /**
+     * Position of the packet in file.
+     *
+     * Analogous to cur_frame_pts/dts
+     */
+    int64_t cur_frame_pos[AV_PARSER_PTS_NB];
+
+    /**
+     * Byte position of currently parsed frame in stream.
+     */
+    int64_t pos;
+
+    /**
+     * Previous frame byte position.
+     */
+    int64_t last_pos;
+
+    /**
+     * Duration of the current frame.
+     * For audio, this is in units of 1 / AVCodecContext.sample_rate.
+     * For all other types, this is in units of AVCodecContext.time_base.
+     */
+    int duration;
+
+    enum AVFieldOrder field_order;
+
+    /**
+     * Indicate whether a picture is coded as a frame, top field or bottom field.
+     *
+     * For example, H.264 field_pic_flag equal to 0 corresponds to
+     * AV_PICTURE_STRUCTURE_FRAME. An H.264 picture with field_pic_flag
+     * equal to 1 and bottom_field_flag equal to 0 corresponds to
+     * AV_PICTURE_STRUCTURE_TOP_FIELD.
+     */
+    enum AVPictureStructure picture_structure;
+
+    /**
+     * Picture number incremented in presentation or output order.
+     * This field may be reinitialized at the first picture of a new sequence.
+     *
+     * For example, this corresponds to H.264 PicOrderCnt.
+     */
+    int output_picture_number;
+
+    /**
+     * Dimensions of the decoded video intended for presentation.
+     */
+    int width;
+    int height;
+
+    /**
+     * Dimensions of the coded video.
+     */
+    int coded_width;
+    int coded_height;
+
+    /**
+     * The format of the coded data, corresponds to enum AVPixelFormat for video
+     * and for enum AVSampleFormat for audio.
+     *
+     * Note that a decoder can have considerable freedom in how exactly it
+     * decodes the data, so the format reported here might be different from the
+     * one returned by a decoder.
+     */
+    int format;
+} AVCodecParserContext;
+
+typedef struct AVCodecParser {
+    int codec_ids[5]; /* several codec IDs are permitted */
+    int priv_data_size;
+    int (*parser_init)(AVCodecParserContext *s);
+    /* This callback never returns an error, a negative value means that
+     * the frame start was in a previous packet. */
+    int (*parser_parse)(AVCodecParserContext *s,
+                        AVCodecContext *avctx,
+                        const uint8_t **poutbuf, int *poutbuf_size,
+                        const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size);
+    void (*parser_close)(AVCodecParserContext *s);
+    int (*split)(AVCodecContext *avctx, const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size);
+    struct AVCodecParser *next;
+} AVCodecParser;
+
+/**
+ * Iterate over all registered codec parsers.
+ *
+ * @param opaque a pointer where libavcodec will store the iteration state. Must
+ *               point to NULL to start the iteration.
+ *
+ * @return the next registered codec parser or NULL when the iteration is
+ *         finished
+ */
+const AVCodecParser *av_parser_iterate(void **opaque);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+AVCodecParser *av_parser_next(const AVCodecParser *c);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_register_codec_parser(AVCodecParser *parser);
+AVCodecParserContext *av_parser_init(int codec_id);
+
+/**
+ * Parse a packet.
+ *
+ * @param s             parser context.
+ * @param avctx         codec context.
+ * @param poutbuf       set to pointer to parsed buffer or NULL if not yet finished.
+ * @param poutbuf_size  set to size of parsed buffer or zero if not yet finished.
+ * @param buf           input buffer.
+ * @param buf_size      buffer size in bytes without the padding. I.e. the full buffer
+                        size is assumed to be buf_size + AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE.
+                        To signal EOF, this should be 0 (so that the last frame
+                        can be output).
+ * @param pts           input presentation timestamp.
+ * @param dts           input decoding timestamp.
+ * @param pos           input byte position in stream.
+ * @return the number of bytes of the input bitstream used.
+ *
+ * Example:
+ * @code
+ *   while(in_len){
+ *       len = av_parser_parse2(myparser, AVCodecContext, &data, &size,
+ *                                        in_data, in_len,
+ *                                        pts, dts, pos);
+ *       in_data += len;
+ *       in_len  -= len;
+ *
+ *       if(size)
+ *          decode_frame(data, size);
+ *   }
+ * @endcode
+ */
+int av_parser_parse2(AVCodecParserContext *s,
+                     AVCodecContext *avctx,
+                     uint8_t **poutbuf, int *poutbuf_size,
+                     const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size,
+                     int64_t pts, int64_t dts,
+                     int64_t pos);
+
+/**
+ * @return 0 if the output buffer is a subset of the input, 1 if it is allocated and must be freed
+ * @deprecated use AVBitStreamFilter
+ */
+int av_parser_change(AVCodecParserContext *s,
+                     AVCodecContext *avctx,
+                     uint8_t **poutbuf, int *poutbuf_size,
+                     const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size, int keyframe);
+void av_parser_close(AVCodecParserContext *s);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavc_encoding
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * Find a registered encoder with a matching codec ID.
+ *
+ * @param id AVCodecID of the requested encoder
+ * @return An encoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
+ */
+AVCodec *avcodec_find_encoder(enum AVCodecID id);
+
+/**
+ * Find a registered encoder with the specified name.
+ *
+ * @param name name of the requested encoder
+ * @return An encoder if one was found, NULL otherwise.
+ */
+AVCodec *avcodec_find_encoder_by_name(const char *name);
+
+/**
+ * Encode a frame of audio.
+ *
+ * Takes input samples from frame and writes the next output packet, if
+ * available, to avpkt. The output packet does not necessarily contain data for
+ * the most recent frame, as encoders can delay, split, and combine input frames
+ * internally as needed.
+ *
+ * @param avctx     codec context
+ * @param avpkt     output AVPacket.
+ *                  The user can supply an output buffer by setting
+ *                  avpkt->data and avpkt->size prior to calling the
+ *                  function, but if the size of the user-provided data is not
+ *                  large enough, encoding will fail. If avpkt->data and
+ *                  avpkt->size are set, avpkt->destruct must also be set. All
+ *                  other AVPacket fields will be reset by the encoder using
+ *                  av_init_packet(). If avpkt->data is NULL, the encoder will
+ *                  allocate it. The encoder will set avpkt->size to the size
+ *                  of the output packet.
+ *
+ *                  If this function fails or produces no output, avpkt will be
+ *                  freed using av_packet_unref().
+ * @param[in] frame AVFrame containing the raw audio data to be encoded.
+ *                  May be NULL when flushing an encoder that has the
+ *                  AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY capability set.
+ *                  If AV_CODEC_CAP_VARIABLE_FRAME_SIZE is set, then each frame
+ *                  can have any number of samples.
+ *                  If it is not set, frame->nb_samples must be equal to
+ *                  avctx->frame_size for all frames except the last.
+ *                  The final frame may be smaller than avctx->frame_size.
+ * @param[out] got_packet_ptr This field is set to 1 by libavcodec if the
+ *                            output packet is non-empty, and to 0 if it is
+ *                            empty. If the function returns an error, the
+ *                            packet can be assumed to be invalid, and the
+ *                            value of got_packet_ptr is undefined and should
+ *                            not be used.
+ * @return          0 on success, negative error code on failure
+ *
+ * @deprecated use avcodec_send_frame()/avcodec_receive_packet() instead
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avcodec_encode_audio2(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVPacket *avpkt,
+                          const AVFrame *frame, int *got_packet_ptr);
+
+/**
+ * Encode a frame of video.
+ *
+ * Takes input raw video data from frame and writes the next output packet, if
+ * available, to avpkt. The output packet does not necessarily contain data for
+ * the most recent frame, as encoders can delay and reorder input frames
+ * internally as needed.
+ *
+ * @param avctx     codec context
+ * @param avpkt     output AVPacket.
+ *                  The user can supply an output buffer by setting
+ *                  avpkt->data and avpkt->size prior to calling the
+ *                  function, but if the size of the user-provided data is not
+ *                  large enough, encoding will fail. All other AVPacket fields
+ *                  will be reset by the encoder using av_init_packet(). If
+ *                  avpkt->data is NULL, the encoder will allocate it.
+ *                  The encoder will set avpkt->size to the size of the
+ *                  output packet. The returned data (if any) belongs to the
+ *                  caller, he is responsible for freeing it.
+ *
+ *                  If this function fails or produces no output, avpkt will be
+ *                  freed using av_packet_unref().
+ * @param[in] frame AVFrame containing the raw video data to be encoded.
+ *                  May be NULL when flushing an encoder that has the
+ *                  AV_CODEC_CAP_DELAY capability set.
+ * @param[out] got_packet_ptr This field is set to 1 by libavcodec if the
+ *                            output packet is non-empty, and to 0 if it is
+ *                            empty. If the function returns an error, the
+ *                            packet can be assumed to be invalid, and the
+ *                            value of got_packet_ptr is undefined and should
+ *                            not be used.
+ * @return          0 on success, negative error code on failure
+ *
+ * @deprecated use avcodec_send_frame()/avcodec_receive_packet() instead
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avcodec_encode_video2(AVCodecContext *avctx, AVPacket *avpkt,
+                          const AVFrame *frame, int *got_packet_ptr);
+
+int avcodec_encode_subtitle(AVCodecContext *avctx, uint8_t *buf, int buf_size,
+                            const AVSubtitle *sub);
+
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#if FF_API_AVPICTURE
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavc_picture
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated unused
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avpicture_alloc(AVPicture *picture, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated unused
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void avpicture_free(AVPicture *picture);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated use av_image_fill_arrays() instead.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avpicture_fill(AVPicture *picture, const uint8_t *ptr,
+                   enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated use av_image_copy_to_buffer() instead.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avpicture_layout(const AVPicture *src, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt,
+                     int width, int height,
+                     unsigned char *dest, int dest_size);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated use av_image_get_buffer_size() instead.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int avpicture_get_size(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated av_image_copy() instead.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_picture_copy(AVPicture *dst, const AVPicture *src,
+                     enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int width, int height);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated unused
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_picture_crop(AVPicture *dst, const AVPicture *src,
+                    enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int top_band, int left_band);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated unused
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_picture_pad(AVPicture *dst, const AVPicture *src, int height, int width, enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt,
+            int padtop, int padbottom, int padleft, int padright, int *color);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_misc Utility functions
+ * @ingroup libavc
+ *
+ * Miscellaneous utility functions related to both encoding and decoding
+ * (or neither).
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_misc_pixfmt Pixel formats
+ *
+ * Functions for working with pixel formats.
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#if FF_API_GETCHROMA
+/**
+ * @deprecated Use av_pix_fmt_get_chroma_sub_sample
+ */
+
+attribute_deprecated
+void avcodec_get_chroma_sub_sample(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt, int *h_shift, int *v_shift);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Return a value representing the fourCC code associated to the
+ * pixel format pix_fmt, or 0 if no associated fourCC code can be
+ * found.
+ */
+unsigned int avcodec_pix_fmt_to_codec_tag(enum AVPixelFormat pix_fmt);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated see av_get_pix_fmt_loss()
+ */
+int avcodec_get_pix_fmt_loss(enum AVPixelFormat dst_pix_fmt, enum AVPixelFormat src_pix_fmt,
+                             int has_alpha);
+
+/**
+ * Find the best pixel format to convert to given a certain source pixel
+ * format.  When converting from one pixel format to another, information loss
+ * may occur.  For example, when converting from RGB24 to GRAY, the color
+ * information will be lost. Similarly, other losses occur when converting from
+ * some formats to other formats. avcodec_find_best_pix_fmt_of_2() searches which of
+ * the given pixel formats should be used to suffer the least amount of loss.
+ * The pixel formats from which it chooses one, are determined by the
+ * pix_fmt_list parameter.
+ *
+ *
+ * @param[in] pix_fmt_list AV_PIX_FMT_NONE terminated array of pixel formats to choose from
+ * @param[in] src_pix_fmt source pixel format
+ * @param[in] has_alpha Whether the source pixel format alpha channel is used.
+ * @param[out] loss_ptr Combination of flags informing you what kind of losses will occur.
+ * @return The best pixel format to convert to or -1 if none was found.
+ */
+enum AVPixelFormat avcodec_find_best_pix_fmt_of_list(const enum AVPixelFormat *pix_fmt_list,
+                                            enum AVPixelFormat src_pix_fmt,
+                                            int has_alpha, int *loss_ptr);
+
+/**
+ * @deprecated see av_find_best_pix_fmt_of_2()
+ */
+enum AVPixelFormat avcodec_find_best_pix_fmt_of_2(enum AVPixelFormat dst_pix_fmt1, enum AVPixelFormat dst_pix_fmt2,
+                                            enum AVPixelFormat src_pix_fmt, int has_alpha, int *loss_ptr);
+
+attribute_deprecated
+enum AVPixelFormat avcodec_find_best_pix_fmt2(enum AVPixelFormat dst_pix_fmt1, enum AVPixelFormat dst_pix_fmt2,
+                                            enum AVPixelFormat src_pix_fmt, int has_alpha, int *loss_ptr);
+
+enum AVPixelFormat avcodec_default_get_format(struct AVCodecContext *s, const enum AVPixelFormat * fmt);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#if FF_API_TAG_STRING
+/**
+ * Put a string representing the codec tag codec_tag in buf.
+ *
+ * @param buf       buffer to place codec tag in
+ * @param buf_size size in bytes of buf
+ * @param codec_tag codec tag to assign
+ * @return the length of the string that would have been generated if
+ * enough space had been available, excluding the trailing null
+ *
+ * @deprecated see av_fourcc_make_string() and av_fourcc2str().
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+size_t av_get_codec_tag_string(char *buf, size_t buf_size, unsigned int codec_tag);
+#endif
+
+void avcodec_string(char *buf, int buf_size, AVCodecContext *enc, int encode);
+
+/**
+ * Return a name for the specified profile, if available.
+ *
+ * @param codec the codec that is searched for the given profile
+ * @param profile the profile value for which a name is requested
+ * @return A name for the profile if found, NULL otherwise.
+ */
+const char *av_get_profile_name(const AVCodec *codec, int profile);
+
+/**
+ * Return a name for the specified profile, if available.
+ *
+ * @param codec_id the ID of the codec to which the requested profile belongs
+ * @param profile the profile value for which a name is requested
+ * @return A name for the profile if found, NULL otherwise.
+ *
+ * @note unlike av_get_profile_name(), which searches a list of profiles
+ *       supported by a specific decoder or encoder implementation, this
+ *       function searches the list of profiles from the AVCodecDescriptor
+ */
+const char *avcodec_profile_name(enum AVCodecID codec_id, int profile);
+
+int avcodec_default_execute(AVCodecContext *c, int (*func)(AVCodecContext *c2, void *arg2),void *arg, int *ret, int count, int size);
+int avcodec_default_execute2(AVCodecContext *c, int (*func)(AVCodecContext *c2, void *arg2, int, int),void *arg, int *ret, int count);
+//FIXME func typedef
+
+/**
+ * Fill AVFrame audio data and linesize pointers.
+ *
+ * The buffer buf must be a preallocated buffer with a size big enough
+ * to contain the specified samples amount. The filled AVFrame data
+ * pointers will point to this buffer.
+ *
+ * AVFrame extended_data channel pointers are allocated if necessary for
+ * planar audio.
+ *
+ * @param frame       the AVFrame
+ *                    frame->nb_samples must be set prior to calling the
+ *                    function. This function fills in frame->data,
+ *                    frame->extended_data, frame->linesize[0].
+ * @param nb_channels channel count
+ * @param sample_fmt  sample format
+ * @param buf         buffer to use for frame data
+ * @param buf_size    size of buffer
+ * @param align       plane size sample alignment (0 = default)
+ * @return            >=0 on success, negative error code on failure
+ * @todo return the size in bytes required to store the samples in
+ * case of success, at the next libavutil bump
+ */
+int avcodec_fill_audio_frame(AVFrame *frame, int nb_channels,
+                             enum AVSampleFormat sample_fmt, const uint8_t *buf,
+                             int buf_size, int align);
+
+/**
+ * Reset the internal decoder state / flush internal buffers. Should be called
+ * e.g. when seeking or when switching to a different stream.
+ *
+ * @note when refcounted frames are not used (i.e. avctx->refcounted_frames is 0),
+ * this invalidates the frames previously returned from the decoder. When
+ * refcounted frames are used, the decoder just releases any references it might
+ * keep internally, but the caller's reference remains valid.
+ */
+void avcodec_flush_buffers(AVCodecContext *avctx);
+
+/**
+ * Return codec bits per sample.
+ *
+ * @param[in] codec_id the codec
+ * @return Number of bits per sample or zero if unknown for the given codec.
+ */
+int av_get_bits_per_sample(enum AVCodecID codec_id);
+
+/**
+ * Return the PCM codec associated with a sample format.
+ * @param be  endianness, 0 for little, 1 for big,
+ *            -1 (or anything else) for native
+ * @return  AV_CODEC_ID_PCM_* or AV_CODEC_ID_NONE
+ */
+enum AVCodecID av_get_pcm_codec(enum AVSampleFormat fmt, int be);
+
+/**
+ * Return codec bits per sample.
+ * Only return non-zero if the bits per sample is exactly correct, not an
+ * approximation.
+ *
+ * @param[in] codec_id the codec
+ * @return Number of bits per sample or zero if unknown for the given codec.
+ */
+int av_get_exact_bits_per_sample(enum AVCodecID codec_id);
+
+/**
+ * Return audio frame duration.
+ *
+ * @param avctx        codec context
+ * @param frame_bytes  size of the frame, or 0 if unknown
+ * @return             frame duration, in samples, if known. 0 if not able to
+ *                     determine.
+ */
+int av_get_audio_frame_duration(AVCodecContext *avctx, int frame_bytes);
+
+/**
+ * This function is the same as av_get_audio_frame_duration(), except it works
+ * with AVCodecParameters instead of an AVCodecContext.
+ */
+int av_get_audio_frame_duration2(AVCodecParameters *par, int frame_bytes);
+
+#if FF_API_OLD_BSF
+typedef struct AVBitStreamFilterContext {
+    void *priv_data;
+    const struct AVBitStreamFilter *filter;
+    AVCodecParserContext *parser;
+    struct AVBitStreamFilterContext *next;
+    /**
+     * Internal default arguments, used if NULL is passed to av_bitstream_filter_filter().
+     * Not for access by library users.
+     */
+    char *args;
+} AVBitStreamFilterContext;
+#endif
+
+typedef struct AVBSFInternal AVBSFInternal;
+
+/**
+ * The bitstream filter state.
+ *
+ * This struct must be allocated with av_bsf_alloc() and freed with
+ * av_bsf_free().
+ *
+ * The fields in the struct will only be changed (by the caller or by the
+ * filter) as described in their documentation, and are to be considered
+ * immutable otherwise.
+ */
+typedef struct AVBSFContext {
+    /**
+     * A class for logging and AVOptions
+     */
+    const AVClass *av_class;
+
+    /**
+     * The bitstream filter this context is an instance of.
+     */
+    const struct AVBitStreamFilter *filter;
+
+    /**
+     * Opaque libavcodec internal data. Must not be touched by the caller in any
+     * way.
+     */
+    AVBSFInternal *internal;
+
+    /**
+     * Opaque filter-specific private data. If filter->priv_class is non-NULL,
+     * this is an AVOptions-enabled struct.
+     */
+    void *priv_data;
+
+    /**
+     * Parameters of the input stream. This field is allocated in
+     * av_bsf_alloc(), it needs to be filled by the caller before
+     * av_bsf_init().
+     */
+    AVCodecParameters *par_in;
+
+    /**
+     * Parameters of the output stream. This field is allocated in
+     * av_bsf_alloc(), it is set by the filter in av_bsf_init().
+     */
+    AVCodecParameters *par_out;
+
+    /**
+     * The timebase used for the timestamps of the input packets. Set by the
+     * caller before av_bsf_init().
+     */
+    AVRational time_base_in;
+
+    /**
+     * The timebase used for the timestamps of the output packets. Set by the
+     * filter in av_bsf_init().
+     */
+    AVRational time_base_out;
+} AVBSFContext;
+
+typedef struct AVBitStreamFilter {
+    const char *name;
+
+    /**
+     * A list of codec ids supported by the filter, terminated by
+     * AV_CODEC_ID_NONE.
+     * May be NULL, in that case the bitstream filter works with any codec id.
+     */
+    const enum AVCodecID *codec_ids;
+
+    /**
+     * A class for the private data, used to declare bitstream filter private
+     * AVOptions. This field is NULL for bitstream filters that do not declare
+     * any options.
+     *
+     * If this field is non-NULL, the first member of the filter private data
+     * must be a pointer to AVClass, which will be set by libavcodec generic
+     * code to this class.
+     */
+    const AVClass *priv_class;
+
+    /*****************************************************************
+     * No fields below this line are part of the public API. They
+     * may not be used outside of libavcodec and can be changed and
+     * removed at will.
+     * New public fields should be added right above.
+     *****************************************************************
+     */
+
+    int priv_data_size;
+    int (*init)(AVBSFContext *ctx);
+    int (*filter)(AVBSFContext *ctx, AVPacket *pkt);
+    void (*close)(AVBSFContext *ctx);
+} AVBitStreamFilter;
+
+#if FF_API_OLD_BSF
+/**
+ * @deprecated the old bitstream filtering API (using AVBitStreamFilterContext)
+ * is deprecated. Use the new bitstream filtering API (using AVBSFContext).
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_register_bitstream_filter(AVBitStreamFilter *bsf);
+/**
+ * @deprecated the old bitstream filtering API (using AVBitStreamFilterContext)
+ * is deprecated. Use av_bsf_get_by_name(), av_bsf_alloc(), and av_bsf_init()
+ * from the new bitstream filtering API (using AVBSFContext).
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+AVBitStreamFilterContext *av_bitstream_filter_init(const char *name);
+/**
+ * @deprecated the old bitstream filtering API (using AVBitStreamFilterContext)
+ * is deprecated. Use av_bsf_send_packet() and av_bsf_receive_packet() from the
+ * new bitstream filtering API (using AVBSFContext).
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_bitstream_filter_filter(AVBitStreamFilterContext *bsfc,
+                               AVCodecContext *avctx, const char *args,
+                               uint8_t **poutbuf, int *poutbuf_size,
+                               const uint8_t *buf, int buf_size, int keyframe);
+/**
+ * @deprecated the old bitstream filtering API (using AVBitStreamFilterContext)
+ * is deprecated. Use av_bsf_free() from the new bitstream filtering API (using
+ * AVBSFContext).
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_bitstream_filter_close(AVBitStreamFilterContext *bsf);
+/**
+ * @deprecated the old bitstream filtering API (using AVBitStreamFilterContext)
+ * is deprecated. Use av_bsf_iterate() from the new bitstream filtering API (using
+ * AVBSFContext).
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+const AVBitStreamFilter *av_bitstream_filter_next(const AVBitStreamFilter *f);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * @return a bitstream filter with the specified name or NULL if no such
+ *         bitstream filter exists.
+ */
+const AVBitStreamFilter *av_bsf_get_by_name(const char *name);
+
+/**
+ * Iterate over all registered bitstream filters.
+ *
+ * @param opaque a pointer where libavcodec will store the iteration state. Must
+ *               point to NULL to start the iteration.
+ *
+ * @return the next registered bitstream filter or NULL when the iteration is
+ *         finished
+ */
+const AVBitStreamFilter *av_bsf_iterate(void **opaque);
+#if FF_API_NEXT
+attribute_deprecated
+const AVBitStreamFilter *av_bsf_next(void **opaque);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Allocate a context for a given bitstream filter. The caller must fill in the
+ * context parameters as described in the documentation and then call
+ * av_bsf_init() before sending any data to the filter.
+ *
+ * @param filter the filter for which to allocate an instance.
+ * @param ctx a pointer into which the pointer to the newly-allocated context
+ *            will be written. It must be freed with av_bsf_free() after the
+ *            filtering is done.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure
+ */
+int av_bsf_alloc(const AVBitStreamFilter *filter, AVBSFContext **ctx);
+
+/**
+ * Prepare the filter for use, after all the parameters and options have been
+ * set.
+ */
+int av_bsf_init(AVBSFContext *ctx);
+
+/**
+ * Submit a packet for filtering.
+ *
+ * After sending each packet, the filter must be completely drained by calling
+ * av_bsf_receive_packet() repeatedly until it returns AVERROR(EAGAIN) or
+ * AVERROR_EOF.
+ *
+ * @param pkt the packet to filter. The bitstream filter will take ownership of
+ * the packet and reset the contents of pkt. pkt is not touched if an error occurs.
+ * This parameter may be NULL, which signals the end of the stream (i.e. no more
+ * packets will be sent). That will cause the filter to output any packets it
+ * may have buffered internally.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on error.
+ */
+int av_bsf_send_packet(AVBSFContext *ctx, AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Retrieve a filtered packet.
+ *
+ * @param[out] pkt this struct will be filled with the contents of the filtered
+ *                 packet. It is owned by the caller and must be freed using
+ *                 av_packet_unref() when it is no longer needed.
+ *                 This parameter should be "clean" (i.e. freshly allocated
+ *                 with av_packet_alloc() or unreffed with av_packet_unref())
+ *                 when this function is called. If this function returns
+ *                 successfully, the contents of pkt will be completely
+ *                 overwritten by the returned data. On failure, pkt is not
+ *                 touched.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success. AVERROR(EAGAIN) if more packets need to be sent to the
+ * filter (using av_bsf_send_packet()) to get more output. AVERROR_EOF if there
+ * will be no further output from the filter. Another negative AVERROR value if
+ * an error occurs.
+ *
+ * @note one input packet may result in several output packets, so after sending
+ * a packet with av_bsf_send_packet(), this function needs to be called
+ * repeatedly until it stops returning 0. It is also possible for a filter to
+ * output fewer packets than were sent to it, so this function may return
+ * AVERROR(EAGAIN) immediately after a successful av_bsf_send_packet() call.
+ */
+int av_bsf_receive_packet(AVBSFContext *ctx, AVPacket *pkt);
+
+/**
+ * Free a bitstream filter context and everything associated with it; write NULL
+ * into the supplied pointer.
+ */
+void av_bsf_free(AVBSFContext **ctx);
+
+/**
+ * Get the AVClass for AVBSFContext. It can be used in combination with
+ * AV_OPT_SEARCH_FAKE_OBJ for examining options.
+ *
+ * @see av_opt_find().
+ */
+const AVClass *av_bsf_get_class(void);
+
+/**
+ * Structure for chain/list of bitstream filters.
+ * Empty list can be allocated by av_bsf_list_alloc().
+ */
+typedef struct AVBSFList AVBSFList;
+
+/**
+ * Allocate empty list of bitstream filters.
+ * The list must be later freed by av_bsf_list_free()
+ * or finalized by av_bsf_list_finalize().
+ *
+ * @return Pointer to @ref AVBSFList on success, NULL in case of failure
+ */
+AVBSFList *av_bsf_list_alloc(void);
+
+/**
+ * Free list of bitstream filters.
+ *
+ * @param lst Pointer to pointer returned by av_bsf_list_alloc()
+ */
+void av_bsf_list_free(AVBSFList **lst);
+
+/**
+ * Append bitstream filter to the list of bitstream filters.
+ *
+ * @param lst List to append to
+ * @param bsf Filter context to be appended
+ *
+ * @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
+ */
+int av_bsf_list_append(AVBSFList *lst, AVBSFContext *bsf);
+
+/**
+ * Construct new bitstream filter context given it's name and options
+ * and append it to the list of bitstream filters.
+ *
+ * @param lst      List to append to
+ * @param bsf_name Name of the bitstream filter
+ * @param options  Options for the bitstream filter, can be set to NULL
+ *
+ * @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
+ */
+int av_bsf_list_append2(AVBSFList *lst, const char * bsf_name, AVDictionary **options);
+/**
+ * Finalize list of bitstream filters.
+ *
+ * This function will transform @ref AVBSFList to single @ref AVBSFContext,
+ * so the whole chain of bitstream filters can be treated as single filter
+ * freshly allocated by av_bsf_alloc().
+ * If the call is successful, @ref AVBSFList structure is freed and lst
+ * will be set to NULL. In case of failure, caller is responsible for
+ * freeing the structure by av_bsf_list_free()
+ *
+ * @param      lst Filter list structure to be transformed
+ * @param[out] bsf Pointer to be set to newly created @ref AVBSFContext structure
+ *                 representing the chain of bitstream filters
+ *
+ * @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
+ */
+int av_bsf_list_finalize(AVBSFList **lst, AVBSFContext **bsf);
+
+/**
+ * Parse string describing list of bitstream filters and create single
+ * @ref AVBSFContext describing the whole chain of bitstream filters.
+ * Resulting @ref AVBSFContext can be treated as any other @ref AVBSFContext freshly
+ * allocated by av_bsf_alloc().
+ *
+ * @param      str String describing chain of bitstream filters in format
+ *                 `bsf1[=opt1=val1:opt2=val2][,bsf2]`
+ * @param[out] bsf Pointer to be set to newly created @ref AVBSFContext structure
+ *                 representing the chain of bitstream filters
+ *
+ * @return >=0 on success, negative AVERROR in case of failure
+ */
+int av_bsf_list_parse_str(const char *str, AVBSFContext **bsf);
+
+/**
+ * Get null/pass-through bitstream filter.
+ *
+ * @param[out] bsf Pointer to be set to new instance of pass-through bitstream filter
+ *
+ * @return
+ */
+int av_bsf_get_null_filter(AVBSFContext **bsf);
+
+/* memory */
+
+/**
+ * Same behaviour av_fast_malloc but the buffer has additional
+ * AV_INPUT_BUFFER_PADDING_SIZE at the end which will always be 0.
+ *
+ * In addition the whole buffer will initially and after resizes
+ * be 0-initialized so that no uninitialized data will ever appear.
+ */
+void av_fast_padded_malloc(void *ptr, unsigned int *size, size_t min_size);
+
+/**
+ * Same behaviour av_fast_padded_malloc except that buffer will always
+ * be 0-initialized after call.
+ */
+void av_fast_padded_mallocz(void *ptr, unsigned int *size, size_t min_size);
+
+/**
+ * Encode extradata length to a buffer. Used by xiph codecs.
+ *
+ * @param s buffer to write to; must be at least (v/255+1) bytes long
+ * @param v size of extradata in bytes
+ * @return number of bytes written to the buffer.
+ */
+unsigned int av_xiphlacing(unsigned char *s, unsigned int v);
+
+#if FF_API_USER_VISIBLE_AVHWACCEL
+/**
+ * Register the hardware accelerator hwaccel.
+ *
+ * @deprecated  This function doesn't do anything.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+void av_register_hwaccel(AVHWAccel *hwaccel);
+
+/**
+ * If hwaccel is NULL, returns the first registered hardware accelerator,
+ * if hwaccel is non-NULL, returns the next registered hardware accelerator
+ * after hwaccel, or NULL if hwaccel is the last one.
+ *
+ * @deprecated  AVHWaccel structures contain no user-serviceable parts, so
+ *              this function should not be used.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+AVHWAccel *av_hwaccel_next(const AVHWAccel *hwaccel);
+#endif
+
+#if FF_API_LOCKMGR
+/**
+ * Lock operation used by lockmgr
+ *
+ * @deprecated Deprecated together with av_lockmgr_register().
+ */
+enum AVLockOp {
+  AV_LOCK_CREATE,  ///< Create a mutex
+  AV_LOCK_OBTAIN,  ///< Lock the mutex
+  AV_LOCK_RELEASE, ///< Unlock the mutex
+  AV_LOCK_DESTROY, ///< Free mutex resources
+};
+
+/**
+ * Register a user provided lock manager supporting the operations
+ * specified by AVLockOp. The "mutex" argument to the function points
+ * to a (void *) where the lockmgr should store/get a pointer to a user
+ * allocated mutex. It is NULL upon AV_LOCK_CREATE and equal to the
+ * value left by the last call for all other ops. If the lock manager is
+ * unable to perform the op then it should leave the mutex in the same
+ * state as when it was called and return a non-zero value. However,
+ * when called with AV_LOCK_DESTROY the mutex will always be assumed to
+ * have been successfully destroyed. If av_lockmgr_register succeeds
+ * it will return a non-negative value, if it fails it will return a
+ * negative value and destroy all mutex and unregister all callbacks.
+ * av_lockmgr_register is not thread-safe, it must be called from a
+ * single thread before any calls which make use of locking are used.
+ *
+ * @param cb User defined callback. av_lockmgr_register invokes calls
+ *           to this callback and the previously registered callback.
+ *           The callback will be used to create more than one mutex
+ *           each of which must be backed by its own underlying locking
+ *           mechanism (i.e. do not use a single static object to
+ *           implement your lock manager). If cb is set to NULL the
+ *           lockmgr will be unregistered.
+ *
+ * @deprecated This function does nothing, and always returns 0. Be sure to
+ *             build with thread support to get basic thread safety.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_lockmgr_register(int (*cb)(void **mutex, enum AVLockOp op));
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Get the type of the given codec.
+ */
+enum AVMediaType avcodec_get_type(enum AVCodecID codec_id);
+
+/**
+ * Get the name of a codec.
+ * @return  a static string identifying the codec; never NULL
+ */
+const char *avcodec_get_name(enum AVCodecID id);
+
+/**
+ * @return a positive value if s is open (i.e. avcodec_open2() was called on it
+ * with no corresponding avcodec_close()), 0 otherwise.
+ */
+int avcodec_is_open(AVCodecContext *s);
+
+/**
+ * @return a non-zero number if codec is an encoder, zero otherwise
+ */
+int av_codec_is_encoder(const AVCodec *codec);
+
+/**
+ * @return a non-zero number if codec is a decoder, zero otherwise
+ */
+int av_codec_is_decoder(const AVCodec *codec);
+
+/**
+ * @return descriptor for given codec ID or NULL if no descriptor exists.
+ */
+const AVCodecDescriptor *avcodec_descriptor_get(enum AVCodecID id);
+
+/**
+ * Iterate over all codec descriptors known to libavcodec.
+ *
+ * @param prev previous descriptor. NULL to get the first descriptor.
+ *
+ * @return next descriptor or NULL after the last descriptor
+ */
+const AVCodecDescriptor *avcodec_descriptor_next(const AVCodecDescriptor *prev);
+
+/**
+ * @return codec descriptor with the given name or NULL if no such descriptor
+ *         exists.
+ */
+const AVCodecDescriptor *avcodec_descriptor_get_by_name(const char *name);
+
+/**
+ * Allocate a CPB properties structure and initialize its fields to default
+ * values.
+ *
+ * @param size if non-NULL, the size of the allocated struct will be written
+ *             here. This is useful for embedding it in side data.
+ *
+ * @return the newly allocated struct or NULL on failure
+ */
+AVCPBProperties *av_cpb_properties_alloc(size_t *size);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVCODEC_AVCODEC_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/avfft.h
@@ -0,0 +1,118 @@
+/*
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVCODEC_AVFFT_H
+#define AVCODEC_AVFFT_H
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup lavc_fft
+ * FFT functions
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_fft FFT functions
+ * @ingroup lavc_misc
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+typedef float FFTSample;
+
+typedef struct FFTComplex {
+    FFTSample re, im;
+} FFTComplex;
+
+typedef struct FFTContext FFTContext;
+
+/**
+ * Set up a complex FFT.
+ * @param nbits           log2 of the length of the input array
+ * @param inverse         if 0 perform the forward transform, if 1 perform the inverse
+ */
+FFTContext *av_fft_init(int nbits, int inverse);
+
+/**
+ * Do the permutation needed BEFORE calling ff_fft_calc().
+ */
+void av_fft_permute(FFTContext *s, FFTComplex *z);
+
+/**
+ * Do a complex FFT with the parameters defined in av_fft_init(). The
+ * input data must be permuted before. No 1.0/sqrt(n) normalization is done.
+ */
+void av_fft_calc(FFTContext *s, FFTComplex *z);
+
+void av_fft_end(FFTContext *s);
+
+FFTContext *av_mdct_init(int nbits, int inverse, double scale);
+void av_imdct_calc(FFTContext *s, FFTSample *output, const FFTSample *input);
+void av_imdct_half(FFTContext *s, FFTSample *output, const FFTSample *input);
+void av_mdct_calc(FFTContext *s, FFTSample *output, const FFTSample *input);
+void av_mdct_end(FFTContext *s);
+
+/* Real Discrete Fourier Transform */
+
+enum RDFTransformType {
+    DFT_R2C,
+    IDFT_C2R,
+    IDFT_R2C,
+    DFT_C2R,
+};
+
+typedef struct RDFTContext RDFTContext;
+
+/**
+ * Set up a real FFT.
+ * @param nbits           log2 of the length of the input array
+ * @param trans           the type of transform
+ */
+RDFTContext *av_rdft_init(int nbits, enum RDFTransformType trans);
+void av_rdft_calc(RDFTContext *s, FFTSample *data);
+void av_rdft_end(RDFTContext *s);
+
+/* Discrete Cosine Transform */
+
+typedef struct DCTContext DCTContext;
+
+enum DCTTransformType {
+    DCT_II = 0,
+    DCT_III,
+    DCT_I,
+    DST_I,
+};
+
+/**
+ * Set up DCT.
+ *
+ * @param nbits           size of the input array:
+ *                        (1 << nbits)     for DCT-II, DCT-III and DST-I
+ *                        (1 << nbits) + 1 for DCT-I
+ * @param type            the type of transform
+ *
+ * @note the first element of the input of DST-I is ignored
+ */
+DCTContext *av_dct_init(int nbits, enum DCTTransformType type);
+void av_dct_calc(DCTContext *s, FFTSample *data);
+void av_dct_end (DCTContext *s);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVCODEC_AVFFT_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/vaapi.h
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+/*
+ * Video Acceleration API (shared data between FFmpeg and the video player)
+ * HW decode acceleration for MPEG-2, MPEG-4, H.264 and VC-1
+ *
+ * Copyright (C) 2008-2009 Splitted-Desktop Systems
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVCODEC_VAAPI_H
+#define AVCODEC_VAAPI_H
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_vaapi
+ * Public libavcodec VA API header.
+ */
+
+#include <stdint.h>
+#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
+#include "version.h"
+
+#if FF_API_STRUCT_VAAPI_CONTEXT
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_vaapi VA API Decoding
+ * @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * This structure is used to share data between the FFmpeg library and
+ * the client video application.
+ * This shall be zero-allocated and available as
+ * AVCodecContext.hwaccel_context. All user members can be set once
+ * during initialization or through each AVCodecContext.get_buffer()
+ * function call. In any case, they must be valid prior to calling
+ * decoding functions.
+ *
+ * Deprecated: use AVCodecContext.hw_frames_ctx instead.
+ */
+struct attribute_deprecated vaapi_context {
+    /**
+     * Window system dependent data
+     *
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user
+     */
+    void *display;
+
+    /**
+     * Configuration ID
+     *
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user
+     */
+    uint32_t config_id;
+
+    /**
+     * Context ID (video decode pipeline)
+     *
+     * - encoding: unused
+     * - decoding: Set by user
+     */
+    uint32_t context_id;
+};
+
+/* @} */
+
+#endif /* FF_API_STRUCT_VAAPI_CONTEXT */
+
+#endif /* AVCODEC_VAAPI_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/vdpau.h
@@ -0,0 +1,176 @@
+/*
+ * The Video Decode and Presentation API for UNIX (VDPAU) is used for
+ * hardware-accelerated decoding of MPEG-1/2, H.264 and VC-1.
+ *
+ * Copyright (C) 2008 NVIDIA
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVCODEC_VDPAU_H
+#define AVCODEC_VDPAU_H
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_vdpau
+ * Public libavcodec VDPAU header.
+ */
+
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavc_codec_hwaccel_vdpau VDPAU Decoder and Renderer
+ * @ingroup lavc_codec_hwaccel
+ *
+ * VDPAU hardware acceleration has two modules
+ * - VDPAU decoding
+ * - VDPAU presentation
+ *
+ * The VDPAU decoding module parses all headers using FFmpeg
+ * parsing mechanisms and uses VDPAU for the actual decoding.
+ *
+ * As per the current implementation, the actual decoding
+ * and rendering (API calls) are done as part of the VDPAU
+ * presentation (vo_vdpau.c) module.
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#include <vdpau/vdpau.h>
+
+#include "libavutil/avconfig.h"
+#include "libavutil/attributes.h"
+
+#include "avcodec.h"
+#include "version.h"
+
+struct AVCodecContext;
+struct AVFrame;
+
+typedef int (*AVVDPAU_Render2)(struct AVCodecContext *, struct AVFrame *,
+                               const VdpPictureInfo *, uint32_t,
+                               const VdpBitstreamBuffer *);
+
+/**
+ * This structure is used to share data between the libavcodec library and
+ * the client video application.
+ * The user shall allocate the structure via the av_alloc_vdpau_hwaccel
+ * function and make it available as
+ * AVCodecContext.hwaccel_context. Members can be set by the user once
+ * during initialization or through each AVCodecContext.get_buffer()
+ * function call. In any case, they must be valid prior to calling
+ * decoding functions.
+ *
+ * The size of this structure is not a part of the public ABI and must not
+ * be used outside of libavcodec. Use av_vdpau_alloc_context() to allocate an
+ * AVVDPAUContext.
+ */
+typedef struct AVVDPAUContext {
+    /**
+     * VDPAU decoder handle
+     *
+     * Set by user.
+     */
+    VdpDecoder decoder;
+
+    /**
+     * VDPAU decoder render callback
+     *
+     * Set by the user.
+     */
+    VdpDecoderRender *render;
+
+    AVVDPAU_Render2 render2;
+} AVVDPAUContext;
+
+/**
+ * @brief allocation function for AVVDPAUContext
+ *
+ * Allows extending the struct without breaking API/ABI
+ */
+AVVDPAUContext *av_alloc_vdpaucontext(void);
+
+AVVDPAU_Render2 av_vdpau_hwaccel_get_render2(const AVVDPAUContext *);
+void av_vdpau_hwaccel_set_render2(AVVDPAUContext *, AVVDPAU_Render2);
+
+/**
+ * Associate a VDPAU device with a codec context for hardware acceleration.
+ * This function is meant to be called from the get_format() codec callback,
+ * or earlier. It can also be called after avcodec_flush_buffers() to change
+ * the underlying VDPAU device mid-stream (e.g. to recover from non-transparent
+ * display preemption).
+ *
+ * @note get_format() must return AV_PIX_FMT_VDPAU if this function completes
+ * successfully.
+ *
+ * @param avctx decoding context whose get_format() callback is invoked
+ * @param device VDPAU device handle to use for hardware acceleration
+ * @param get_proc_address VDPAU device driver
+ * @param flags zero of more OR'd AV_HWACCEL_FLAG_* flags
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, an AVERROR code on failure.
+ */
+int av_vdpau_bind_context(AVCodecContext *avctx, VdpDevice device,
+                          VdpGetProcAddress *get_proc_address, unsigned flags);
+
+/**
+ * Gets the parameters to create an adequate VDPAU video surface for the codec
+ * context using VDPAU hardware decoding acceleration.
+ *
+ * @note Behavior is undefined if the context was not successfully bound to a
+ * VDPAU device using av_vdpau_bind_context().
+ *
+ * @param avctx the codec context being used for decoding the stream
+ * @param type storage space for the VDPAU video surface chroma type
+ *              (or NULL to ignore)
+ * @param width storage space for the VDPAU video surface pixel width
+ *              (or NULL to ignore)
+ * @param height storage space for the VDPAU video surface pixel height
+ *              (or NULL to ignore)
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR code on failure.
+ */
+int av_vdpau_get_surface_parameters(AVCodecContext *avctx, VdpChromaType *type,
+                                    uint32_t *width, uint32_t *height);
+
+/**
+ * Allocate an AVVDPAUContext.
+ *
+ * @return Newly-allocated AVVDPAUContext or NULL on failure.
+ */
+AVVDPAUContext *av_vdpau_alloc_context(void);
+
+#if FF_API_VDPAU_PROFILE
+/**
+ * Get a decoder profile that should be used for initializing a VDPAU decoder.
+ * Should be called from the AVCodecContext.get_format() callback.
+ *
+ * @deprecated Use av_vdpau_bind_context() instead.
+ *
+ * @param avctx the codec context being used for decoding the stream
+ * @param profile a pointer into which the result will be written on success.
+ *                The contents of profile are undefined if this function returns
+ *                an error.
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success (non-negative), a negative AVERROR on failure.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_vdpau_get_profile(AVCodecContext *avctx, VdpDecoderProfile *profile);
+#endif
+
+/* @}*/
+
+#endif /* AVCODEC_VDPAU_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavcodec/version.h
@@ -0,0 +1,137 @@
+/*
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVCODEC_VERSION_H
+#define AVCODEC_VERSION_H
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup libavc
+ * Libavcodec version macros.
+ */
+
+#include "libavutil/version.h"
+
+#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR  58
+#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MINOR  18
+#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MICRO 100
+
+#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_INT  AV_VERSION_INT(LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR, \
+                                               LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MINOR, \
+                                               LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MICRO)
+#define LIBAVCODEC_VERSION      AV_VERSION(LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR,    \
+                                           LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MINOR,    \
+                                           LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MICRO)
+#define LIBAVCODEC_BUILD        LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_INT
+
+#define LIBAVCODEC_IDENT        "Lavc" AV_STRINGIFY(LIBAVCODEC_VERSION)
+
+/**
+ * FF_API_* defines may be placed below to indicate public API that will be
+ * dropped at a future version bump. The defines themselves are not part of
+ * the public API and may change, break or disappear at any time.
+ *
+ * @note, when bumping the major version it is recommended to manually
+ * disable each FF_API_* in its own commit instead of disabling them all
+ * at once through the bump. This improves the git bisect-ability of the change.
+ */
+
+#ifndef FF_API_LOWRES
+#define FF_API_LOWRES            (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_DEBUG_MV
+#define FF_API_DEBUG_MV          (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 58)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_AVCTX_TIMEBASE
+#define FF_API_AVCTX_TIMEBASE    (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_CODED_FRAME
+#define FF_API_CODED_FRAME       (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_SIDEDATA_ONLY_PKT
+#define FF_API_SIDEDATA_ONLY_PKT (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_VDPAU_PROFILE
+#define FF_API_VDPAU_PROFILE     (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_CONVERGENCE_DURATION
+#define FF_API_CONVERGENCE_DURATION (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_AVPICTURE
+#define FF_API_AVPICTURE         (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_AVPACKET_OLD_API
+#define FF_API_AVPACKET_OLD_API (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_RTP_CALLBACK
+#define FF_API_RTP_CALLBACK      (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_VBV_DELAY
+#define FF_API_VBV_DELAY         (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_CODER_TYPE
+#define FF_API_CODER_TYPE        (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_STAT_BITS
+#define FF_API_STAT_BITS         (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT
+#define FF_API_PRIVATE_OPT      (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_ASS_TIMING
+#define FF_API_ASS_TIMING       (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_OLD_BSF
+#define FF_API_OLD_BSF          (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_COPY_CONTEXT
+#define FF_API_COPY_CONTEXT     (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_GET_CONTEXT_DEFAULTS
+#define FF_API_GET_CONTEXT_DEFAULTS (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_NVENC_OLD_NAME
+#define FF_API_NVENC_OLD_NAME    (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_STRUCT_VAAPI_CONTEXT
+#define FF_API_STRUCT_VAAPI_CONTEXT (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_MERGE_SD_API
+#define FF_API_MERGE_SD_API      (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_TAG_STRING
+#define FF_API_TAG_STRING        (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_GETCHROMA
+#define FF_API_GETCHROMA         (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_CODEC_GET_SET
+#define FF_API_CODEC_GET_SET     (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_USER_VISIBLE_AVHWACCEL
+#define FF_API_USER_VISIBLE_AVHWACCEL (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_LOCKMGR
+#define FF_API_LOCKMGR (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+#ifndef FF_API_NEXT
+#define FF_API_NEXT              (LIBAVCODEC_VERSION_MAJOR < 59)
+#endif
+
+
+#endif /* AVCODEC_VERSION_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/attributes.h
@@ -0,0 +1,167 @@
+/*
+ * copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * Macro definitions for various function/variable attributes
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_ATTRIBUTES_H
+#define AVUTIL_ATTRIBUTES_H
+
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+#    define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(x,y) (__GNUC__ > (x) || __GNUC__ == (x) && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= (y))
+#    define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_MOST(x,y)  (__GNUC__ < (x) || __GNUC__ == (x) && __GNUC_MINOR__ <= (y))
+#else
+#    define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(x,y) 0
+#    define AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_MOST(x,y)  0
+#endif
+
+#ifndef av_always_inline
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1)
+#    define av_always_inline __attribute__((always_inline)) inline
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+#    define av_always_inline __forceinline
+#else
+#    define av_always_inline inline
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef av_extern_inline
+#if defined(__ICL) && __ICL >= 1210 || defined(__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__)
+#    define av_extern_inline extern inline
+#else
+#    define av_extern_inline inline
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,4)
+#    define av_warn_unused_result __attribute__((warn_unused_result))
+#else
+#    define av_warn_unused_result
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1)
+#    define av_noinline __attribute__((noinline))
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+#    define av_noinline __declspec(noinline)
+#else
+#    define av_noinline
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_pure __attribute__((pure))
+#else
+#    define av_pure
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(2,6) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_const __attribute__((const))
+#else
+#    define av_const
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(4,3) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_cold __attribute__((cold))
+#else
+#    define av_cold
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(4,1) && !defined(__llvm__)
+#    define av_flatten __attribute__((flatten))
+#else
+#    define av_flatten
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1)
+#    define attribute_deprecated __attribute__((deprecated))
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+#    define attribute_deprecated __declspec(deprecated)
+#else
+#    define attribute_deprecated
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Disable warnings about deprecated features
+ * This is useful for sections of code kept for backward compatibility and
+ * scheduled for removal.
+ */
+#ifndef AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(4,6)
+#    define AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED(code) \
+        _Pragma("GCC diagnostic push") \
+        _Pragma("GCC diagnostic ignored \"-Wdeprecated-declarations\"") \
+        code \
+        _Pragma("GCC diagnostic pop")
+#elif defined(_MSC_VER)
+#    define AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED(code) \
+        __pragma(warning(push)) \
+        __pragma(warning(disable : 4996)) \
+        code; \
+        __pragma(warning(pop))
+#else
+#    define AV_NOWARN_DEPRECATED(code) code
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_unused __attribute__((unused))
+#else
+#    define av_unused
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Mark a variable as used and prevent the compiler from optimizing it
+ * away.  This is useful for variables accessed only from inline
+ * assembler without the compiler being aware.
+ */
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,1) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_used __attribute__((used))
+#else
+#    define av_used
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(3,3) || defined(__clang__)
+#   define av_alias __attribute__((may_alias))
+#else
+#   define av_alias
+#endif
+
+#if (defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)) && !defined(__INTEL_COMPILER)
+#    define av_uninit(x) x=x
+#else
+#    define av_uninit(x) x
+#endif
+
+#if defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_builtin_constant_p __builtin_constant_p
+#    define av_printf_format(fmtpos, attrpos) __attribute__((__format__(__printf__, fmtpos, attrpos)))
+#else
+#    define av_builtin_constant_p(x) 0
+#    define av_printf_format(fmtpos, attrpos)
+#endif
+
+#if AV_GCC_VERSION_AT_LEAST(2,5) || defined(__clang__)
+#    define av_noreturn __attribute__((noreturn))
+#else
+#    define av_noreturn
+#endif
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_ATTRIBUTES_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/avconfig.h
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+/* Generated by ffmpeg configure */
+#ifndef AVUTIL_AVCONFIG_H
+#define AVUTIL_AVCONFIG_H
+#define AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN 0
+#define AV_HAVE_FAST_UNALIGNED 1
+#endif /* AVUTIL_AVCONFIG_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/avutil.h
@@ -0,0 +1,365 @@
+/*
+ * copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_AVUTIL_H
+#define AVUTIL_AVUTIL_H
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup lavu
+ * Convenience header that includes @ref lavu "libavutil"'s core.
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @mainpage
+ *
+ * @section ffmpeg_intro Introduction
+ *
+ * This document describes the usage of the different libraries
+ * provided by FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * @li @ref libavc "libavcodec" encoding/decoding library
+ * @li @ref lavfi "libavfilter" graph-based frame editing library
+ * @li @ref libavf "libavformat" I/O and muxing/demuxing library
+ * @li @ref lavd "libavdevice" special devices muxing/demuxing library
+ * @li @ref lavu "libavutil" common utility library
+ * @li @ref lswr "libswresample" audio resampling, format conversion and mixing
+ * @li @ref lpp  "libpostproc" post processing library
+ * @li @ref libsws "libswscale" color conversion and scaling library
+ *
+ * @section ffmpeg_versioning Versioning and compatibility
+ *
+ * Each of the FFmpeg libraries contains a version.h header, which defines a
+ * major, minor and micro version number with the
+ * <em>LIBRARYNAME_VERSION_{MAJOR,MINOR,MICRO}</em> macros. The major version
+ * number is incremented with backward incompatible changes - e.g. removing
+ * parts of the public API, reordering public struct members, etc. The minor
+ * version number is incremented for backward compatible API changes or major
+ * new features - e.g. adding a new public function or a new decoder. The micro
+ * version number is incremented for smaller changes that a calling program
+ * might still want to check for - e.g. changing behavior in a previously
+ * unspecified situation.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg guarantees backward API and ABI compatibility for each library as long
+ * as its major version number is unchanged. This means that no public symbols
+ * will be removed or renamed. Types and names of the public struct members and
+ * values of public macros and enums will remain the same (unless they were
+ * explicitly declared as not part of the public API). Documented behavior will
+ * not change.
+ *
+ * In other words, any correct program that works with a given FFmpeg snapshot
+ * should work just as well without any changes with any later snapshot with the
+ * same major versions. This applies to both rebuilding the program against new
+ * FFmpeg versions or to replacing the dynamic FFmpeg libraries that a program
+ * links against.
+ *
+ * However, new public symbols may be added and new members may be appended to
+ * public structs whose size is not part of public ABI (most public structs in
+ * FFmpeg). New macros and enum values may be added. Behavior in undocumented
+ * situations may change slightly (and be documented). All those are accompanied
+ * by an entry in doc/APIchanges and incrementing either the minor or micro
+ * version number.
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavu libavutil
+ * Common code shared across all FFmpeg libraries.
+ *
+ * @note
+ * libavutil is designed to be modular. In most cases, in order to use the
+ * functions provided by one component of libavutil you must explicitly include
+ * the specific header containing that feature. If you are only using
+ * media-related components, you could simply include libavutil/avutil.h, which
+ * brings in most of the "core" components.
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_crypto Crypto and Hashing
+ *
+ * @{
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_math Mathematics
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_string String Manipulation
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_mem Memory Management
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_data Data Structures
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_video Video related
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_audio Audio related
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_error Error Codes
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_log Logging Facility
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_misc Other
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @defgroup preproc_misc Preprocessor String Macros
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ *
+ * @defgroup version_utils Library Version Macros
+ *
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @}
+ */
+
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavu_ver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * Return the LIBAVUTIL_VERSION_INT constant.
+ */
+unsigned avutil_version(void);
+
+/**
+ * Return an informative version string. This usually is the actual release
+ * version number or a git commit description. This string has no fixed format
+ * and can change any time. It should never be parsed by code.
+ */
+const char *av_version_info(void);
+
+/**
+ * Return the libavutil build-time configuration.
+ */
+const char *avutil_configuration(void);
+
+/**
+ * Return the libavutil license.
+ */
+const char *avutil_license(void);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavu_media Media Type
+ * @brief Media Type
+ */
+
+enum AVMediaType {
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_UNKNOWN = -1,  ///< Usually treated as AVMEDIA_TYPE_DATA
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_VIDEO,
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_AUDIO,
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_DATA,          ///< Opaque data information usually continuous
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_SUBTITLE,
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_ATTACHMENT,    ///< Opaque data information usually sparse
+    AVMEDIA_TYPE_NB
+};
+
+/**
+ * Return a string describing the media_type enum, NULL if media_type
+ * is unknown.
+ */
+const char *av_get_media_type_string(enum AVMediaType media_type);
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavu_const Constants
+ * @{
+ *
+ * @defgroup lavu_enc Encoding specific
+ *
+ * @note those definition should move to avcodec
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FF_LAMBDA_SHIFT 7
+#define FF_LAMBDA_SCALE (1<<FF_LAMBDA_SHIFT)
+#define FF_QP2LAMBDA 118 ///< factor to convert from H.263 QP to lambda
+#define FF_LAMBDA_MAX (256*128-1)
+
+#define FF_QUALITY_SCALE FF_LAMBDA_SCALE //FIXME maybe remove
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ * @defgroup lavu_time Timestamp specific
+ *
+ * FFmpeg internal timebase and timestamp definitions
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Undefined timestamp value
+ *
+ * Usually reported by demuxer that work on containers that do not provide
+ * either pts or dts.
+ */
+
+#define AV_NOPTS_VALUE          ((int64_t)UINT64_C(0x8000000000000000))
+
+/**
+ * Internal time base represented as integer
+ */
+
+#define AV_TIME_BASE            1000000
+
+/**
+ * Internal time base represented as fractional value
+ */
+
+#define AV_TIME_BASE_Q          (AVRational){1, AV_TIME_BASE}
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ * @}
+ * @defgroup lavu_picture Image related
+ *
+ * AVPicture types, pixel formats and basic image planes manipulation.
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+enum AVPictureType {
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_NONE = 0, ///< Undefined
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_I,     ///< Intra
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_P,     ///< Predicted
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_B,     ///< Bi-dir predicted
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_S,     ///< S(GMC)-VOP MPEG-4
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_SI,    ///< Switching Intra
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_SP,    ///< Switching Predicted
+    AV_PICTURE_TYPE_BI,    ///< BI type
+};
+
+/**
+ * Return a single letter to describe the given picture type
+ * pict_type.
+ *
+ * @param[in] pict_type the picture type @return a single character
+ * representing the picture type, '?' if pict_type is unknown
+ */
+char av_get_picture_type_char(enum AVPictureType pict_type);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#include "common.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "rational.h"
+#include "version.h"
+#include "macros.h"
+#include "mathematics.h"
+#include "log.h"
+#include "pixfmt.h"
+
+/**
+ * Return x default pointer in case p is NULL.
+ */
+static inline void *av_x_if_null(const void *p, const void *x)
+{
+    return (void *)(intptr_t)(p ? p : x);
+}
+
+/**
+ * Compute the length of an integer list.
+ *
+ * @param elsize  size in bytes of each list element (only 1, 2, 4 or 8)
+ * @param term    list terminator (usually 0 or -1)
+ * @param list    pointer to the list
+ * @return  length of the list, in elements, not counting the terminator
+ */
+unsigned av_int_list_length_for_size(unsigned elsize,
+                                     const void *list, uint64_t term) av_pure;
+
+/**
+ * Compute the length of an integer list.
+ *
+ * @param term  list terminator (usually 0 or -1)
+ * @param list  pointer to the list
+ * @return  length of the list, in elements, not counting the terminator
+ */
+#define av_int_list_length(list, term) \
+    av_int_list_length_for_size(sizeof(*(list)), list, term)
+
+/**
+ * Open a file using a UTF-8 filename.
+ * The API of this function matches POSIX fopen(), errors are returned through
+ * errno.
+ */
+FILE *av_fopen_utf8(const char *path, const char *mode);
+
+/**
+ * Return the fractional representation of the internal time base.
+ */
+AVRational av_get_time_base_q(void);
+
+#define AV_FOURCC_MAX_STRING_SIZE 32
+
+#define av_fourcc2str(fourcc) av_fourcc_make_string((char[AV_FOURCC_MAX_STRING_SIZE]){0}, fourcc)
+
+/**
+ * Fill the provided buffer with a string containing a FourCC (four-character
+ * code) representation.
+ *
+ * @param buf    a buffer with size in bytes of at least AV_FOURCC_MAX_STRING_SIZE
+ * @param fourcc the fourcc to represent
+ * @return the buffer in input
+ */
+char *av_fourcc_make_string(char *buf, uint32_t fourcc);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_AVUTIL_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/buffer.h
@@ -0,0 +1,291 @@
+/*
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * @ingroup lavu_buffer
+ * refcounted data buffer API
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_BUFFER_H
+#define AVUTIL_BUFFER_H
+
+#include <stdint.h>
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavu_buffer AVBuffer
+ * @ingroup lavu_data
+ *
+ * @{
+ * AVBuffer is an API for reference-counted data buffers.
+ *
+ * There are two core objects in this API -- AVBuffer and AVBufferRef. AVBuffer
+ * represents the data buffer itself; it is opaque and not meant to be accessed
+ * by the caller directly, but only through AVBufferRef. However, the caller may
+ * e.g. compare two AVBuffer pointers to check whether two different references
+ * are describing the same data buffer. AVBufferRef represents a single
+ * reference to an AVBuffer and it is the object that may be manipulated by the
+ * caller directly.
+ *
+ * There are two functions provided for creating a new AVBuffer with a single
+ * reference -- av_buffer_alloc() to just allocate a new buffer, and
+ * av_buffer_create() to wrap an existing array in an AVBuffer. From an existing
+ * reference, additional references may be created with av_buffer_ref().
+ * Use av_buffer_unref() to free a reference (this will automatically free the
+ * data once all the references are freed).
+ *
+ * The convention throughout this API and the rest of FFmpeg is such that the
+ * buffer is considered writable if there exists only one reference to it (and
+ * it has not been marked as read-only). The av_buffer_is_writable() function is
+ * provided to check whether this is true and av_buffer_make_writable() will
+ * automatically create a new writable buffer when necessary.
+ * Of course nothing prevents the calling code from violating this convention,
+ * however that is safe only when all the existing references are under its
+ * control.
+ *
+ * @note Referencing and unreferencing the buffers is thread-safe and thus
+ * may be done from multiple threads simultaneously without any need for
+ * additional locking.
+ *
+ * @note Two different references to the same buffer can point to different
+ * parts of the buffer (i.e. their AVBufferRef.data will not be equal).
+ */
+
+/**
+ * A reference counted buffer type. It is opaque and is meant to be used through
+ * references (AVBufferRef).
+ */
+typedef struct AVBuffer AVBuffer;
+
+/**
+ * A reference to a data buffer.
+ *
+ * The size of this struct is not a part of the public ABI and it is not meant
+ * to be allocated directly.
+ */
+typedef struct AVBufferRef {
+    AVBuffer *buffer;
+
+    /**
+     * The data buffer. It is considered writable if and only if
+     * this is the only reference to the buffer, in which case
+     * av_buffer_is_writable() returns 1.
+     */
+    uint8_t *data;
+    /**
+     * Size of data in bytes.
+     */
+    int      size;
+} AVBufferRef;
+
+/**
+ * Allocate an AVBuffer of the given size using av_malloc().
+ *
+ * @return an AVBufferRef of given size or NULL when out of memory
+ */
+AVBufferRef *av_buffer_alloc(int size);
+
+/**
+ * Same as av_buffer_alloc(), except the returned buffer will be initialized
+ * to zero.
+ */
+AVBufferRef *av_buffer_allocz(int size);
+
+/**
+ * Always treat the buffer as read-only, even when it has only one
+ * reference.
+ */
+#define AV_BUFFER_FLAG_READONLY (1 << 0)
+
+/**
+ * Create an AVBuffer from an existing array.
+ *
+ * If this function is successful, data is owned by the AVBuffer. The caller may
+ * only access data through the returned AVBufferRef and references derived from
+ * it.
+ * If this function fails, data is left untouched.
+ * @param data   data array
+ * @param size   size of data in bytes
+ * @param free   a callback for freeing this buffer's data
+ * @param opaque parameter to be got for processing or passed to free
+ * @param flags  a combination of AV_BUFFER_FLAG_*
+ *
+ * @return an AVBufferRef referring to data on success, NULL on failure.
+ */
+AVBufferRef *av_buffer_create(uint8_t *data, int size,
+                              void (*free)(void *opaque, uint8_t *data),
+                              void *opaque, int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Default free callback, which calls av_free() on the buffer data.
+ * This function is meant to be passed to av_buffer_create(), not called
+ * directly.
+ */
+void av_buffer_default_free(void *opaque, uint8_t *data);
+
+/**
+ * Create a new reference to an AVBuffer.
+ *
+ * @return a new AVBufferRef referring to the same AVBuffer as buf or NULL on
+ * failure.
+ */
+AVBufferRef *av_buffer_ref(AVBufferRef *buf);
+
+/**
+ * Free a given reference and automatically free the buffer if there are no more
+ * references to it.
+ *
+ * @param buf the reference to be freed. The pointer is set to NULL on return.
+ */
+void av_buffer_unref(AVBufferRef **buf);
+
+/**
+ * @return 1 if the caller may write to the data referred to by buf (which is
+ * true if and only if buf is the only reference to the underlying AVBuffer).
+ * Return 0 otherwise.
+ * A positive answer is valid until av_buffer_ref() is called on buf.
+ */
+int av_buffer_is_writable(const AVBufferRef *buf);
+
+/**
+ * @return the opaque parameter set by av_buffer_create.
+ */
+void *av_buffer_get_opaque(const AVBufferRef *buf);
+
+int av_buffer_get_ref_count(const AVBufferRef *buf);
+
+/**
+ * Create a writable reference from a given buffer reference, avoiding data copy
+ * if possible.
+ *
+ * @param buf buffer reference to make writable. On success, buf is either left
+ *            untouched, or it is unreferenced and a new writable AVBufferRef is
+ *            written in its place. On failure, buf is left untouched.
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on failure.
+ */
+int av_buffer_make_writable(AVBufferRef **buf);
+
+/**
+ * Reallocate a given buffer.
+ *
+ * @param buf  a buffer reference to reallocate. On success, buf will be
+ *             unreferenced and a new reference with the required size will be
+ *             written in its place. On failure buf will be left untouched. *buf
+ *             may be NULL, then a new buffer is allocated.
+ * @param size required new buffer size.
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative AVERROR on failure.
+ *
+ * @note the buffer is actually reallocated with av_realloc() only if it was
+ * initially allocated through av_buffer_realloc(NULL) and there is only one
+ * reference to it (i.e. the one passed to this function). In all other cases
+ * a new buffer is allocated and the data is copied.
+ */
+int av_buffer_realloc(AVBufferRef **buf, int size);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup lavu_bufferpool AVBufferPool
+ * @ingroup lavu_data
+ *
+ * @{
+ * AVBufferPool is an API for a lock-free thread-safe pool of AVBuffers.
+ *
+ * Frequently allocating and freeing large buffers may be slow. AVBufferPool is
+ * meant to solve this in cases when the caller needs a set of buffers of the
+ * same size (the most obvious use case being buffers for raw video or audio
+ * frames).
+ *
+ * At the beginning, the user must call av_buffer_pool_init() to create the
+ * buffer pool. Then whenever a buffer is needed, call av_buffer_pool_get() to
+ * get a reference to a new buffer, similar to av_buffer_alloc(). This new
+ * reference works in all aspects the same way as the one created by
+ * av_buffer_alloc(). However, when the last reference to this buffer is
+ * unreferenced, it is returned to the pool instead of being freed and will be
+ * reused for subsequent av_buffer_pool_get() calls.
+ *
+ * When the caller is done with the pool and no longer needs to allocate any new
+ * buffers, av_buffer_pool_uninit() must be called to mark the pool as freeable.
+ * Once all the buffers are released, it will automatically be freed.
+ *
+ * Allocating and releasing buffers with this API is thread-safe as long as
+ * either the default alloc callback is used, or the user-supplied one is
+ * thread-safe.
+ */
+
+/**
+ * The buffer pool. This structure is opaque and not meant to be accessed
+ * directly. It is allocated with av_buffer_pool_init() and freed with
+ * av_buffer_pool_uninit().
+ */
+typedef struct AVBufferPool AVBufferPool;
+
+/**
+ * Allocate and initialize a buffer pool.
+ *
+ * @param size size of each buffer in this pool
+ * @param alloc a function that will be used to allocate new buffers when the
+ * pool is empty. May be NULL, then the default allocator will be used
+ * (av_buffer_alloc()).
+ * @return newly created buffer pool on success, NULL on error.
+ */
+AVBufferPool *av_buffer_pool_init(int size, AVBufferRef* (*alloc)(int size));
+
+/**
+ * Allocate and initialize a buffer pool with a more complex allocator.
+ *
+ * @param size size of each buffer in this pool
+ * @param opaque arbitrary user data used by the allocator
+ * @param alloc a function that will be used to allocate new buffers when the
+ *              pool is empty.
+ * @param pool_free a function that will be called immediately before the pool
+ *                  is freed. I.e. after av_buffer_pool_uninit() is called
+ *                  by the caller and all the frames are returned to the pool
+ *                  and freed. It is intended to uninitialize the user opaque
+ *                  data.
+ * @return newly created buffer pool on success, NULL on error.
+ */
+AVBufferPool *av_buffer_pool_init2(int size, void *opaque,
+                                   AVBufferRef* (*alloc)(void *opaque, int size),
+                                   void (*pool_free)(void *opaque));
+
+/**
+ * Mark the pool as being available for freeing. It will actually be freed only
+ * once all the allocated buffers associated with the pool are released. Thus it
+ * is safe to call this function while some of the allocated buffers are still
+ * in use.
+ *
+ * @param pool pointer to the pool to be freed. It will be set to NULL.
+ */
+void av_buffer_pool_uninit(AVBufferPool **pool);
+
+/**
+ * Allocate a new AVBuffer, reusing an old buffer from the pool when available.
+ * This function may be called simultaneously from multiple threads.
+ *
+ * @return a reference to the new buffer on success, NULL on error.
+ */
+AVBufferRef *av_buffer_pool_get(AVBufferPool *pool);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_BUFFER_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/channel_layout.h
@@ -0,0 +1,232 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
+ * Copyright (c) 2008 Peter Ross
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_H
+#define AVUTIL_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_H
+
+#include <stdint.h>
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * audio channel layout utility functions
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavu_audio
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @defgroup channel_masks Audio channel masks
+ *
+ * A channel layout is a 64-bits integer with a bit set for every channel.
+ * The number of bits set must be equal to the number of channels.
+ * The value 0 means that the channel layout is not known.
+ * @note this data structure is not powerful enough to handle channels
+ * combinations that have the same channel multiple times, such as
+ * dual-mono.
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+#define AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT             0x00000001
+#define AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT            0x00000002
+#define AV_CH_FRONT_CENTER           0x00000004
+#define AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY          0x00000008
+#define AV_CH_BACK_LEFT              0x00000010
+#define AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT             0x00000020
+#define AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER   0x00000040
+#define AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER  0x00000080
+#define AV_CH_BACK_CENTER            0x00000100
+#define AV_CH_SIDE_LEFT              0x00000200
+#define AV_CH_SIDE_RIGHT             0x00000400
+#define AV_CH_TOP_CENTER             0x00000800
+#define AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT         0x00001000
+#define AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_CENTER       0x00002000
+#define AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT        0x00004000
+#define AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT          0x00008000
+#define AV_CH_TOP_BACK_CENTER        0x00010000
+#define AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT         0x00020000
+#define AV_CH_STEREO_LEFT            0x20000000  ///< Stereo downmix.
+#define AV_CH_STEREO_RIGHT           0x40000000  ///< See AV_CH_STEREO_LEFT.
+#define AV_CH_WIDE_LEFT              0x0000000080000000ULL
+#define AV_CH_WIDE_RIGHT             0x0000000100000000ULL
+#define AV_CH_SURROUND_DIRECT_LEFT   0x0000000200000000ULL
+#define AV_CH_SURROUND_DIRECT_RIGHT  0x0000000400000000ULL
+#define AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY_2        0x0000000800000000ULL
+
+/** Channel mask value used for AVCodecContext.request_channel_layout
+    to indicate that the user requests the channel order of the decoder output
+    to be the native codec channel order. */
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_NATIVE          0x8000000000000000ULL
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ * @defgroup channel_mask_c Audio channel layouts
+ * @{
+ * */
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO              (AV_CH_FRONT_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO            (AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_2POINT1           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_1               (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND          (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_FRONT_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_3POINT1           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT0           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT1           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_4POINT0|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_2               (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_SIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_SIDE_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_QUAD              (AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_SIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_SIDE_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK      (AV_CH_LAYOUT_SURROUND|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK      (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0_FRONT     (AV_CH_LAYOUT_2_2|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_HEXAGONAL         (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0_BACK|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1_BACK      (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT1_FRONT     (AV_CH_LAYOUT_6POINT0_FRONT|AV_CH_LOW_FREQUENCY)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT0           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT0_FRONT     (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1           (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE      (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_7POINT1_WIDE_BACK (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT1_BACK|AV_CH_FRONT_LEFT_OF_CENTER|AV_CH_FRONT_RIGHT_OF_CENTER)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_OCTAGONAL         (AV_CH_LAYOUT_5POINT0|AV_CH_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_BACK_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_HEXADECAGONAL     (AV_CH_LAYOUT_OCTAGONAL|AV_CH_WIDE_LEFT|AV_CH_WIDE_RIGHT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_RIGHT|AV_CH_TOP_BACK_CENTER|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_CENTER|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_LEFT|AV_CH_TOP_FRONT_RIGHT)
+#define AV_CH_LAYOUT_STEREO_DOWNMIX    (AV_CH_STEREO_LEFT|AV_CH_STEREO_RIGHT)
+
+enum AVMatrixEncoding {
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_NONE,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DOLBY,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DPLII,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DPLIIX,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DPLIIZ,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DOLBYEX,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_DOLBYHEADPHONE,
+    AV_MATRIX_ENCODING_NB
+};
+
+/**
+ * Return a channel layout id that matches name, or 0 if no match is found.
+ *
+ * name can be one or several of the following notations,
+ * separated by '+' or '|':
+ * - the name of an usual channel layout (mono, stereo, 4.0, quad, 5.0,
+ *   5.0(side), 5.1, 5.1(side), 7.1, 7.1(wide), downmix);
+ * - the name of a single channel (FL, FR, FC, LFE, BL, BR, FLC, FRC, BC,
+ *   SL, SR, TC, TFL, TFC, TFR, TBL, TBC, TBR, DL, DR);
+ * - a number of channels, in decimal, followed by 'c', yielding
+ *   the default channel layout for that number of channels (@see
+ *   av_get_default_channel_layout);
+ * - a channel layout mask, in hexadecimal starting with "0x" (see the
+ *   AV_CH_* macros).
+ *
+ * Example: "stereo+FC" = "2c+FC" = "2c+1c" = "0x7"
+ */
+uint64_t av_get_channel_layout(const char *name);
+
+/**
+ * Return a channel layout and the number of channels based on the specified name.
+ *
+ * This function is similar to (@see av_get_channel_layout), but can also parse
+ * unknown channel layout specifications.
+ *
+ * @param[in]  name             channel layout specification string
+ * @param[out] channel_layout   parsed channel layout (0 if unknown)
+ * @param[out] nb_channels      number of channels
+ *
+ * @return 0 on success, AVERROR(EINVAL) if the parsing fails.
+ */
+int av_get_extended_channel_layout(const char *name, uint64_t* channel_layout, int* nb_channels);
+
+/**
+ * Return a description of a channel layout.
+ * If nb_channels is <= 0, it is guessed from the channel_layout.
+ *
+ * @param buf put here the string containing the channel layout
+ * @param buf_size size in bytes of the buffer
+ */
+void av_get_channel_layout_string(char *buf, int buf_size, int nb_channels, uint64_t channel_layout);
+
+struct AVBPrint;
+/**
+ * Append a description of a channel layout to a bprint buffer.
+ */
+void av_bprint_channel_layout(struct AVBPrint *bp, int nb_channels, uint64_t channel_layout);
+
+/**
+ * Return the number of channels in the channel layout.
+ */
+int av_get_channel_layout_nb_channels(uint64_t channel_layout);
+
+/**
+ * Return default channel layout for a given number of channels.
+ */
+int64_t av_get_default_channel_layout(int nb_channels);
+
+/**
+ * Get the index of a channel in channel_layout.
+ *
+ * @param channel a channel layout describing exactly one channel which must be
+ *                present in channel_layout.
+ *
+ * @return index of channel in channel_layout on success, a negative AVERROR
+ *         on error.
+ */
+int av_get_channel_layout_channel_index(uint64_t channel_layout,
+                                        uint64_t channel);
+
+/**
+ * Get the channel with the given index in channel_layout.
+ */
+uint64_t av_channel_layout_extract_channel(uint64_t channel_layout, int index);
+
+/**
+ * Get the name of a given channel.
+ *
+ * @return channel name on success, NULL on error.
+ */
+const char *av_get_channel_name(uint64_t channel);
+
+/**
+ * Get the description of a given channel.
+ *
+ * @param channel  a channel layout with a single channel
+ * @return  channel description on success, NULL on error
+ */
+const char *av_get_channel_description(uint64_t channel);
+
+/**
+ * Get the value and name of a standard channel layout.
+ *
+ * @param[in]  index   index in an internal list, starting at 0
+ * @param[out] layout  channel layout mask
+ * @param[out] name    name of the layout
+ * @return  0  if the layout exists,
+ *          <0 if index is beyond the limits
+ */
+int av_get_standard_channel_layout(unsigned index, uint64_t *layout,
+                                   const char **name);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_CHANNEL_LAYOUT_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/common.h
@@ -0,0 +1,560 @@
+/*
+ * copyright (c) 2006 Michael Niedermayer <michaelni@gmx.at>
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * common internal and external API header
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_COMMON_H
+#define AVUTIL_COMMON_H
+
+#if defined(__cplusplus) && !defined(__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS) && !defined(UINT64_C)
+#error missing -D__STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS / #define __STDC_CONSTANT_MACROS
+#endif
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <inttypes.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <math.h>
+#include <stdint.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "attributes.h"
+#include "macros.h"
+#include "version.h"
+#include "libavutil/avconfig.h"
+
+#if AV_HAVE_BIGENDIAN
+#   define AV_NE(be, le) (be)
+#else
+#   define AV_NE(be, le) (le)
+#endif
+
+//rounded division & shift
+#define RSHIFT(a,b) ((a) > 0 ? ((a) + ((1<<(b))>>1))>>(b) : ((a) + ((1<<(b))>>1)-1)>>(b))
+/* assume b>0 */
+#define ROUNDED_DIV(a,b) (((a)>0 ? (a) + ((b)>>1) : (a) - ((b)>>1))/(b))
+/* Fast a/(1<<b) rounded toward +inf. Assume a>=0 and b>=0 */
+#define AV_CEIL_RSHIFT(a,b) (!av_builtin_constant_p(b) ? -((-(a)) >> (b)) \
+                                                       : ((a) + (1<<(b)) - 1) >> (b))
+/* Backwards compat. */
+#define FF_CEIL_RSHIFT AV_CEIL_RSHIFT
+
+#define FFUDIV(a,b) (((a)>0 ?(a):(a)-(b)+1) / (b))
+#define FFUMOD(a,b) ((a)-(b)*FFUDIV(a,b))
+
+/**
+ * Absolute value, Note, INT_MIN / INT64_MIN result in undefined behavior as they
+ * are not representable as absolute values of their type. This is the same
+ * as with *abs()
+ * @see FFNABS()
+ */
+#define FFABS(a) ((a) >= 0 ? (a) : (-(a)))
+#define FFSIGN(a) ((a) > 0 ? 1 : -1)
+
+/**
+ * Negative Absolute value.
+ * this works for all integers of all types.
+ * As with many macros, this evaluates its argument twice, it thus must not have
+ * a sideeffect, that is FFNABS(x++) has undefined behavior.
+ */
+#define FFNABS(a) ((a) <= 0 ? (a) : (-(a)))
+
+/**
+ * Comparator.
+ * For two numerical expressions x and y, gives 1 if x > y, -1 if x < y, and 0
+ * if x == y. This is useful for instance in a qsort comparator callback.
+ * Furthermore, compilers are able to optimize this to branchless code, and
+ * there is no risk of overflow with signed types.
+ * As with many macros, this evaluates its argument multiple times, it thus
+ * must not have a side-effect.
+ */
+#define FFDIFFSIGN(x,y) (((x)>(y)) - ((x)<(y)))
+
+#define FFMAX(a,b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
+#define FFMAX3(a,b,c) FFMAX(FFMAX(a,b),c)
+#define FFMIN(a,b) ((a) > (b) ? (b) : (a))
+#define FFMIN3(a,b,c) FFMIN(FFMIN(a,b),c)
+
+#define FFSWAP(type,a,b) do{type SWAP_tmp= b; b= a; a= SWAP_tmp;}while(0)
+#define FF_ARRAY_ELEMS(a) (sizeof(a) / sizeof((a)[0]))
+
+/* misc math functions */
+
+#ifdef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
+#   include "config.h"
+#   include "intmath.h"
+#endif
+
+/* Pull in unguarded fallback defines at the end of this file. */
+#include "common.h"
+
+#ifndef av_log2
+av_const int av_log2(unsigned v);
+#endif
+
+#ifndef av_log2_16bit
+av_const int av_log2_16bit(unsigned v);
+#endif
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer value into the amin-amax range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @param amin minimum value of the clip range
+ * @param amax maximum value of the clip range
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int av_clip_c(int a, int amin, int amax)
+{
+#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
+    if (amin > amax) abort();
+#endif
+    if      (a < amin) return amin;
+    else if (a > amax) return amax;
+    else               return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed 64bit integer value into the amin-amax range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @param amin minimum value of the clip range
+ * @param amax maximum value of the clip range
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int64_t av_clip64_c(int64_t a, int64_t amin, int64_t amax)
+{
+#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
+    if (amin > amax) abort();
+#endif
+    if      (a < amin) return amin;
+    else if (a > amax) return amax;
+    else               return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer value into the 0-255 range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const uint8_t av_clip_uint8_c(int a)
+{
+    if (a&(~0xFF)) return (~a)>>31;
+    else           return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer value into the -128,127 range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int8_t av_clip_int8_c(int a)
+{
+    if ((a+0x80U) & ~0xFF) return (a>>31) ^ 0x7F;
+    else                  return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer value into the 0-65535 range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const uint16_t av_clip_uint16_c(int a)
+{
+    if (a&(~0xFFFF)) return (~a)>>31;
+    else             return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer value into the -32768,32767 range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int16_t av_clip_int16_c(int a)
+{
+    if ((a+0x8000U) & ~0xFFFF) return (a>>31) ^ 0x7FFF;
+    else                      return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed 64-bit integer value into the -2147483648,2147483647 range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int32_t av_clipl_int32_c(int64_t a)
+{
+    if ((a+0x80000000u) & ~UINT64_C(0xFFFFFFFF)) return (int32_t)((a>>63) ^ 0x7FFFFFFF);
+    else                                         return (int32_t)a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer into the -(2^p),(2^p-1) range.
+ * @param  a value to clip
+ * @param  p bit position to clip at
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int av_clip_intp2_c(int a, int p)
+{
+    if (((unsigned)a + (1 << p)) & ~((2 << p) - 1))
+        return (a >> 31) ^ ((1 << p) - 1);
+    else
+        return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a signed integer to an unsigned power of two range.
+ * @param  a value to clip
+ * @param  p bit position to clip at
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const unsigned av_clip_uintp2_c(int a, int p)
+{
+    if (a & ~((1<<p) - 1)) return -a >> 31 & ((1<<p) - 1);
+    else                   return  a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clear high bits from an unsigned integer starting with specific bit position
+ * @param  a value to clip
+ * @param  p bit position to clip at
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const unsigned av_mod_uintp2_c(unsigned a, unsigned p)
+{
+    return a & ((1 << p) - 1);
+}
+
+/**
+ * Add two signed 32-bit values with saturation.
+ *
+ * @param  a one value
+ * @param  b another value
+ * @return sum with signed saturation
+ */
+static av_always_inline int av_sat_add32_c(int a, int b)
+{
+    return av_clipl_int32((int64_t)a + b);
+}
+
+/**
+ * Add a doubled value to another value with saturation at both stages.
+ *
+ * @param  a first value
+ * @param  b value doubled and added to a
+ * @return sum sat(a + sat(2*b)) with signed saturation
+ */
+static av_always_inline int av_sat_dadd32_c(int a, int b)
+{
+    return av_sat_add32(a, av_sat_add32(b, b));
+}
+
+/**
+ * Subtract two signed 32-bit values with saturation.
+ *
+ * @param  a one value
+ * @param  b another value
+ * @return difference with signed saturation
+ */
+static av_always_inline int av_sat_sub32_c(int a, int b)
+{
+    return av_clipl_int32((int64_t)a - b);
+}
+
+/**
+ * Subtract a doubled value from another value with saturation at both stages.
+ *
+ * @param  a first value
+ * @param  b value doubled and subtracted from a
+ * @return difference sat(a - sat(2*b)) with signed saturation
+ */
+static av_always_inline int av_sat_dsub32_c(int a, int b)
+{
+    return av_sat_sub32(a, av_sat_add32(b, b));
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a float value into the amin-amax range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @param amin minimum value of the clip range
+ * @param amax maximum value of the clip range
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const float av_clipf_c(float a, float amin, float amax)
+{
+#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
+    if (amin > amax) abort();
+#endif
+    if      (a < amin) return amin;
+    else if (a > amax) return amax;
+    else               return a;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Clip a double value into the amin-amax range.
+ * @param a value to clip
+ * @param amin minimum value of the clip range
+ * @param amax maximum value of the clip range
+ * @return clipped value
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const double av_clipd_c(double a, double amin, double amax)
+{
+#if defined(HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H) && defined(ASSERT_LEVEL) && ASSERT_LEVEL >= 2
+    if (amin > amax) abort();
+#endif
+    if      (a < amin) return amin;
+    else if (a > amax) return amax;
+    else               return a;
+}
+
+/** Compute ceil(log2(x)).
+ * @param x value used to compute ceil(log2(x))
+ * @return computed ceiling of log2(x)
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int av_ceil_log2_c(int x)
+{
+    return av_log2((x - 1) << 1);
+}
+
+/**
+ * Count number of bits set to one in x
+ * @param x value to count bits of
+ * @return the number of bits set to one in x
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int av_popcount_c(uint32_t x)
+{
+    x -= (x >> 1) & 0x55555555;
+    x = (x & 0x33333333) + ((x >> 2) & 0x33333333);
+    x = (x + (x >> 4)) & 0x0F0F0F0F;
+    x += x >> 8;
+    return (x + (x >> 16)) & 0x3F;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Count number of bits set to one in x
+ * @param x value to count bits of
+ * @return the number of bits set to one in x
+ */
+static av_always_inline av_const int av_popcount64_c(uint64_t x)
+{
+    return av_popcount((uint32_t)x) + av_popcount((uint32_t)(x >> 32));
+}
+
+static av_always_inline av_const int av_parity_c(uint32_t v)
+{
+    return av_popcount(v) & 1;
+}
+
+#define MKTAG(a,b,c,d) ((a) | ((b) << 8) | ((c) << 16) | ((unsigned)(d) << 24))
+#define MKBETAG(a,b,c,d) ((d) | ((c) << 8) | ((b) << 16) | ((unsigned)(a) << 24))
+
+/**
+ * Convert a UTF-8 character (up to 4 bytes) to its 32-bit UCS-4 encoded form.
+ *
+ * @param val      Output value, must be an lvalue of type uint32_t.
+ * @param GET_BYTE Expression reading one byte from the input.
+ *                 Evaluated up to 7 times (4 for the currently
+ *                 assigned Unicode range).  With a memory buffer
+ *                 input, this could be *ptr++.
+ * @param ERROR    Expression to be evaluated on invalid input,
+ *                 typically a goto statement.
+ *
+ * @warning ERROR should not contain a loop control statement which
+ * could interact with the internal while loop, and should force an
+ * exit from the macro code (e.g. through a goto or a return) in order
+ * to prevent undefined results.
+ */
+#define GET_UTF8(val, GET_BYTE, ERROR)\
+    val= (GET_BYTE);\
+    {\
+        uint32_t top = (val & 128) >> 1;\
+        if ((val & 0xc0) == 0x80 || val >= 0xFE)\
+            ERROR\
+        while (val & top) {\
+            int tmp= (GET_BYTE) - 128;\
+            if(tmp>>6)\
+                ERROR\
+            val= (val<<6) + tmp;\
+            top <<= 5;\
+        }\
+        val &= (top << 1) - 1;\
+    }
+
+/**
+ * Convert a UTF-16 character (2 or 4 bytes) to its 32-bit UCS-4 encoded form.
+ *
+ * @param val       Output value, must be an lvalue of type uint32_t.
+ * @param GET_16BIT Expression returning two bytes of UTF-16 data converted
+ *                  to native byte order.  Evaluated one or two times.
+ * @param ERROR     Expression to be evaluated on invalid input,
+ *                  typically a goto statement.
+ */
+#define GET_UTF16(val, GET_16BIT, ERROR)\
+    val = GET_16BIT;\
+    {\
+        unsigned int hi = val - 0xD800;\
+        if (hi < 0x800) {\
+            val = GET_16BIT - 0xDC00;\
+            if (val > 0x3FFU || hi > 0x3FFU)\
+                ERROR\
+            val += (hi<<10) + 0x10000;\
+        }\
+    }\
+
+/**
+ * @def PUT_UTF8(val, tmp, PUT_BYTE)
+ * Convert a 32-bit Unicode character to its UTF-8 encoded form (up to 4 bytes long).
+ * @param val is an input-only argument and should be of type uint32_t. It holds
+ * a UCS-4 encoded Unicode character that is to be converted to UTF-8. If
+ * val is given as a function it is executed only once.
+ * @param tmp is a temporary variable and should be of type uint8_t. It
+ * represents an intermediate value during conversion that is to be
+ * output by PUT_BYTE.
+ * @param PUT_BYTE writes the converted UTF-8 bytes to any proper destination.
+ * It could be a function or a statement, and uses tmp as the input byte.
+ * For example, PUT_BYTE could be "*output++ = tmp;" PUT_BYTE will be
+ * executed up to 4 times for values in the valid UTF-8 range and up to
+ * 7 times in the general case, depending on the length of the converted
+ * Unicode character.
+ */
+#define PUT_UTF8(val, tmp, PUT_BYTE)\
+    {\
+        int bytes, shift;\
+        uint32_t in = val;\
+        if (in < 0x80) {\
+            tmp = in;\
+            PUT_BYTE\
+        } else {\
+            bytes = (av_log2(in) + 4) / 5;\
+            shift = (bytes - 1) * 6;\
+            tmp = (256 - (256 >> bytes)) | (in >> shift);\
+            PUT_BYTE\
+            while (shift >= 6) {\
+                shift -= 6;\
+                tmp = 0x80 | ((in >> shift) & 0x3f);\
+                PUT_BYTE\
+            }\
+        }\
+    }
+
+/**
+ * @def PUT_UTF16(val, tmp, PUT_16BIT)
+ * Convert a 32-bit Unicode character to its UTF-16 encoded form (2 or 4 bytes).
+ * @param val is an input-only argument and should be of type uint32_t. It holds
+ * a UCS-4 encoded Unicode character that is to be converted to UTF-16. If
+ * val is given as a function it is executed only once.
+ * @param tmp is a temporary variable and should be of type uint16_t. It
+ * represents an intermediate value during conversion that is to be
+ * output by PUT_16BIT.
+ * @param PUT_16BIT writes the converted UTF-16 data to any proper destination
+ * in desired endianness. It could be a function or a statement, and uses tmp
+ * as the input byte.  For example, PUT_BYTE could be "*output++ = tmp;"
+ * PUT_BYTE will be executed 1 or 2 times depending on input character.
+ */
+#define PUT_UTF16(val, tmp, PUT_16BIT)\
+    {\
+        uint32_t in = val;\
+        if (in < 0x10000) {\
+            tmp = in;\
+            PUT_16BIT\
+        } else {\
+            tmp = 0xD800 | ((in - 0x10000) >> 10);\
+            PUT_16BIT\
+            tmp = 0xDC00 | ((in - 0x10000) & 0x3FF);\
+            PUT_16BIT\
+        }\
+    }\
+
+
+
+#include "mem.h"
+
+#ifdef HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H
+#    include "internal.h"
+#endif /* HAVE_AV_CONFIG_H */
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_COMMON_H */
+
+/*
+ * The following definitions are outside the multiple inclusion guard
+ * to ensure they are immediately available in intmath.h.
+ */
+
+#ifndef av_ceil_log2
+#   define av_ceil_log2     av_ceil_log2_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip
+#   define av_clip          av_clip_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip64
+#   define av_clip64        av_clip64_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip_uint8
+#   define av_clip_uint8    av_clip_uint8_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip_int8
+#   define av_clip_int8     av_clip_int8_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip_uint16
+#   define av_clip_uint16   av_clip_uint16_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip_int16
+#   define av_clip_int16    av_clip_int16_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clipl_int32
+#   define av_clipl_int32   av_clipl_int32_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip_intp2
+#   define av_clip_intp2    av_clip_intp2_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clip_uintp2
+#   define av_clip_uintp2   av_clip_uintp2_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_mod_uintp2
+#   define av_mod_uintp2    av_mod_uintp2_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_sat_add32
+#   define av_sat_add32     av_sat_add32_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_sat_dadd32
+#   define av_sat_dadd32    av_sat_dadd32_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_sat_sub32
+#   define av_sat_sub32     av_sat_sub32_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_sat_dsub32
+#   define av_sat_dsub32    av_sat_dsub32_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clipf
+#   define av_clipf         av_clipf_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_clipd
+#   define av_clipd         av_clipd_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_popcount
+#   define av_popcount      av_popcount_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_popcount64
+#   define av_popcount64    av_popcount64_c
+#endif
+#ifndef av_parity
+#   define av_parity        av_parity_c
+#endif
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/cpu.h
@@ -0,0 +1,130 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2000, 2001, 2002 Fabrice Bellard
+ *
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_CPU_H
+#define AVUTIL_CPU_H
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+
+#include "attributes.h"
+
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_FORCE    0x80000000 /* force usage of selected flags (OR) */
+
+    /* lower 16 bits - CPU features */
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMX          0x0001 ///< standard MMX
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMXEXT       0x0002 ///< SSE integer functions or AMD MMX ext
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_MMX2         0x0002 ///< SSE integer functions or AMD MMX ext
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_3DNOW        0x0004 ///< AMD 3DNOW
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE          0x0008 ///< SSE functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE2         0x0010 ///< PIV SSE2 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE2SLOW 0x40000000 ///< SSE2 supported, but usually not faster
+                                        ///< than regular MMX/SSE (e.g. Core1)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_3DNOWEXT     0x0020 ///< AMD 3DNowExt
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE3         0x0040 ///< Prescott SSE3 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE3SLOW 0x20000000 ///< SSE3 supported, but usually not faster
+                                        ///< than regular MMX/SSE (e.g. Core1)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSSE3        0x0080 ///< Conroe SSSE3 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSSE3SLOW 0x4000000 ///< SSSE3 supported, but usually not faster
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ATOM     0x10000000 ///< Atom processor, some SSSE3 instructions are slower
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE4         0x0100 ///< Penryn SSE4.1 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SSE42        0x0200 ///< Nehalem SSE4.2 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AESNI       0x80000 ///< Advanced Encryption Standard functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX          0x4000 ///< AVX functions: requires OS support even if YMM registers aren't used
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVXSLOW   0x8000000 ///< AVX supported, but slow when using YMM registers (e.g. Bulldozer)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_XOP          0x0400 ///< Bulldozer XOP functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_FMA4         0x0800 ///< Bulldozer FMA4 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_CMOV         0x1000 ///< supports cmov instruction
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX2         0x8000 ///< AVX2 functions: requires OS support even if YMM registers aren't used
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_FMA3        0x10000 ///< Haswell FMA3 functions
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_BMI1        0x20000 ///< Bit Manipulation Instruction Set 1
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_BMI2        0x40000 ///< Bit Manipulation Instruction Set 2
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX512     0x100000 ///< AVX-512 functions: requires OS support even if YMM/ZMM registers aren't used
+
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ALTIVEC      0x0001 ///< standard
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VSX          0x0002 ///< ISA 2.06
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_POWER8       0x0004 ///< ISA 2.07
+
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV5TE      (1 << 0)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV6        (1 << 1)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV6T2      (1 << 2)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VFP          (1 << 3)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VFPV3        (1 << 4)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_NEON         (1 << 5)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_ARMV8        (1 << 6)
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_VFP_VM       (1 << 7) ///< VFPv2 vector mode, deprecated in ARMv7-A and unavailable in various CPUs implementations
+#define AV_CPU_FLAG_SETEND       (1 <<16)
+
+/**
+ * Return the flags which specify extensions supported by the CPU.
+ * The returned value is affected by av_force_cpu_flags() if that was used
+ * before. So av_get_cpu_flags() can easily be used in an application to
+ * detect the enabled cpu flags.
+ */
+int av_get_cpu_flags(void);
+
+/**
+ * Disables cpu detection and forces the specified flags.
+ * -1 is a special case that disables forcing of specific flags.
+ */
+void av_force_cpu_flags(int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Set a mask on flags returned by av_get_cpu_flags().
+ * This function is mainly useful for testing.
+ * Please use av_force_cpu_flags() and av_get_cpu_flags() instead which are more flexible
+ */
+attribute_deprecated void av_set_cpu_flags_mask(int mask);
+
+/**
+ * Parse CPU flags from a string.
+ *
+ * The returned flags contain the specified flags as well as related unspecified flags.
+ *
+ * This function exists only for compatibility with libav.
+ * Please use av_parse_cpu_caps() when possible.
+ * @return a combination of AV_CPU_* flags, negative on error.
+ */
+attribute_deprecated
+int av_parse_cpu_flags(const char *s);
+
+/**
+ * Parse CPU caps from a string and update the given AV_CPU_* flags based on that.
+ *
+ * @return negative on error.
+ */
+int av_parse_cpu_caps(unsigned *flags, const char *s);
+
+/**
+ * @return the number of logical CPU cores present.
+ */
+int av_cpu_count(void);
+
+/**
+ * Get the maximum data alignment that may be required by FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * Note that this is affected by the build configuration and the CPU flags mask,
+ * so e.g. if the CPU supports AVX, but libavutil has been built with
+ * --disable-avx or the AV_CPU_FLAG_AVX flag has been disabled through
+ *  av_set_cpu_flags_mask(), then this function will behave as if AVX is not
+ *  present.
+ */
+size_t av_cpu_max_align(void);
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_CPU_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/dict.h
@@ -0,0 +1,200 @@
+/*
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * Public dictionary API.
+ * @deprecated
+ *  AVDictionary is provided for compatibility with libav. It is both in
+ *  implementation as well as API inefficient. It does not scale and is
+ *  extremely slow with large dictionaries.
+ *  It is recommended that new code uses our tree container from tree.c/h
+ *  where applicable, which uses AVL trees to achieve O(log n) performance.
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_DICT_H
+#define AVUTIL_DICT_H
+
+#include <stdint.h>
+
+#include "version.h"
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavu_dict AVDictionary
+ * @ingroup lavu_data
+ *
+ * @brief Simple key:value store
+ *
+ * @{
+ * Dictionaries are used for storing key:value pairs. To create
+ * an AVDictionary, simply pass an address of a NULL pointer to
+ * av_dict_set(). NULL can be used as an empty dictionary wherever
+ * a pointer to an AVDictionary is required.
+ * Use av_dict_get() to retrieve an entry or iterate over all
+ * entries and finally av_dict_free() to free the dictionary
+ * and all its contents.
+ *
+ @code
+   AVDictionary *d = NULL;           // "create" an empty dictionary
+   AVDictionaryEntry *t = NULL;
+
+   av_dict_set(&d, "foo", "bar", 0); // add an entry
+
+   char *k = av_strdup("key");       // if your strings are already allocated,
+   char *v = av_strdup("value");     // you can avoid copying them like this
+   av_dict_set(&d, k, v, AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY | AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL);
+
+   while (t = av_dict_get(d, "", t, AV_DICT_IGNORE_SUFFIX)) {
+       <....>                             // iterate over all entries in d
+   }
+   av_dict_free(&d);
+ @endcode
+ */
+
+#define AV_DICT_MATCH_CASE      1   /**< Only get an entry with exact-case key match. Only relevant in av_dict_get(). */
+#define AV_DICT_IGNORE_SUFFIX   2   /**< Return first entry in a dictionary whose first part corresponds to the search key,
+                                         ignoring the suffix of the found key string. Only relevant in av_dict_get(). */
+#define AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY 4   /**< Take ownership of a key that's been
+                                         allocated with av_malloc() or another memory allocation function. */
+#define AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL 8   /**< Take ownership of a value that's been
+                                         allocated with av_malloc() or another memory allocation function. */
+#define AV_DICT_DONT_OVERWRITE 16   ///< Don't overwrite existing entries.
+#define AV_DICT_APPEND         32   /**< If the entry already exists, append to it.  Note that no
+                                      delimiter is added, the strings are simply concatenated. */
+#define AV_DICT_MULTIKEY       64   /**< Allow to store several equal keys in the dictionary */
+
+typedef struct AVDictionaryEntry {
+    char *key;
+    char *value;
+} AVDictionaryEntry;
+
+typedef struct AVDictionary AVDictionary;
+
+/**
+ * Get a dictionary entry with matching key.
+ *
+ * The returned entry key or value must not be changed, or it will
+ * cause undefined behavior.
+ *
+ * To iterate through all the dictionary entries, you can set the matching key
+ * to the null string "" and set the AV_DICT_IGNORE_SUFFIX flag.
+ *
+ * @param prev Set to the previous matching element to find the next.
+ *             If set to NULL the first matching element is returned.
+ * @param key matching key
+ * @param flags a collection of AV_DICT_* flags controlling how the entry is retrieved
+ * @return found entry or NULL in case no matching entry was found in the dictionary
+ */
+AVDictionaryEntry *av_dict_get(const AVDictionary *m, const char *key,
+                               const AVDictionaryEntry *prev, int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Get number of entries in dictionary.
+ *
+ * @param m dictionary
+ * @return  number of entries in dictionary
+ */
+int av_dict_count(const AVDictionary *m);
+
+/**
+ * Set the given entry in *pm, overwriting an existing entry.
+ *
+ * Note: If AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY or AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL is set,
+ * these arguments will be freed on error.
+ *
+ * Warning: Adding a new entry to a dictionary invalidates all existing entries
+ * previously returned with av_dict_get.
+ *
+ * @param pm pointer to a pointer to a dictionary struct. If *pm is NULL
+ * a dictionary struct is allocated and put in *pm.
+ * @param key entry key to add to *pm (will either be av_strduped or added as a new key depending on flags)
+ * @param value entry value to add to *pm (will be av_strduped or added as a new key depending on flags).
+ *        Passing a NULL value will cause an existing entry to be deleted.
+ * @return >= 0 on success otherwise an error code <0
+ */
+int av_dict_set(AVDictionary **pm, const char *key, const char *value, int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Convenience wrapper for av_dict_set that converts the value to a string
+ * and stores it.
+ *
+ * Note: If AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY is set, key will be freed on error.
+ */
+int av_dict_set_int(AVDictionary **pm, const char *key, int64_t value, int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Parse the key/value pairs list and add the parsed entries to a dictionary.
+ *
+ * In case of failure, all the successfully set entries are stored in
+ * *pm. You may need to manually free the created dictionary.
+ *
+ * @param key_val_sep  a 0-terminated list of characters used to separate
+ *                     key from value
+ * @param pairs_sep    a 0-terminated list of characters used to separate
+ *                     two pairs from each other
+ * @param flags        flags to use when adding to dictionary.
+ *                     AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_KEY and AV_DICT_DONT_STRDUP_VAL
+ *                     are ignored since the key/value tokens will always
+ *                     be duplicated.
+ * @return             0 on success, negative AVERROR code on failure
+ */
+int av_dict_parse_string(AVDictionary **pm, const char *str,
+                         const char *key_val_sep, const char *pairs_sep,
+                         int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Copy entries from one AVDictionary struct into another.
+ * @param dst pointer to a pointer to a AVDictionary struct. If *dst is NULL,
+ *            this function will allocate a struct for you and put it in *dst
+ * @param src pointer to source AVDictionary struct
+ * @param flags flags to use when setting entries in *dst
+ * @note metadata is read using the AV_DICT_IGNORE_SUFFIX flag
+ * @return 0 on success, negative AVERROR code on failure. If dst was allocated
+ *           by this function, callers should free the associated memory.
+ */
+int av_dict_copy(AVDictionary **dst, const AVDictionary *src, int flags);
+
+/**
+ * Free all the memory allocated for an AVDictionary struct
+ * and all keys and values.
+ */
+void av_dict_free(AVDictionary **m);
+
+/**
+ * Get dictionary entries as a string.
+ *
+ * Create a string containing dictionary's entries.
+ * Such string may be passed back to av_dict_parse_string().
+ * @note String is escaped with backslashes ('\').
+ *
+ * @param[in]  m             dictionary
+ * @param[out] buffer        Pointer to buffer that will be allocated with string containg entries.
+ *                           Buffer must be freed by the caller when is no longer needed.
+ * @param[in]  key_val_sep   character used to separate key from value
+ * @param[in]  pairs_sep     character used to separate two pairs from each other
+ * @return                   >= 0 on success, negative on error
+ * @warning Separators cannot be neither '\\' nor '\0'. They also cannot be the same.
+ */
+int av_dict_get_string(const AVDictionary *m, char **buffer,
+                       const char key_val_sep, const char pairs_sep);
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_DICT_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/error.h
@@ -0,0 +1,126 @@
+/*
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+ * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+ * version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+ *
+ * FFmpeg is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+ * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+ * Lesser General Public License for more details.
+ *
+ * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+ * License along with FFmpeg; if not, write to the Free Software
+ * Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @file
+ * error code definitions
+ */
+
+#ifndef AVUTIL_ERROR_H
+#define AVUTIL_ERROR_H
+
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+
+/**
+ * @addtogroup lavu_error
+ *
+ * @{
+ */
+
+
+/* error handling */
+#if EDOM > 0
+#define AVERROR(e) (-(e))   ///< Returns a negative error code from a POSIX error code, to return from library functions.
+#define AVUNERROR(e) (-(e)) ///< Returns a POSIX error code from a library function error return value.
+#else
+/* Some platforms have E* and errno already negated. */
+#define AVERROR(e) (e)
+#define AVUNERROR(e) (e)
+#endif
+
+#define FFERRTAG(a, b, c, d) (-(int)MKTAG(a, b, c, d))
+
+#define AVERROR_BSF_NOT_FOUND      FFERRTAG(0xF8,'B','S','F') ///< Bitstream filter not found
+#define AVERROR_BUG                FFERRTAG( 'B','U','G','!') ///< Internal bug, also see AVERROR_BUG2
+#define AVERROR_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL   FFERRTAG( 'B','U','F','S') ///< Buffer too small
+#define AVERROR_DECODER_NOT_FOUND  FFERRTAG(0xF8,'D','E','C') ///< Decoder not found
+#define AVERROR_DEMUXER_NOT_FOUND  FFERRTAG(0xF8,'D','E','M') ///< Demuxer not found
+#define AVERROR_ENCODER_NOT_FOUND  FFERRTAG(0xF8,'E','N','C') ///< Encoder not found
+#define AVERROR_EOF                FFERRTAG( 'E','O','F',' ') ///< End of file
+#define AVERROR_EXIT               FFERRTAG( 'E','X','I','T') ///< Immediate exit was requested; the called function should not be restarted
+#define AVERROR_EXTERNAL           FFERRTAG( 'E','X','T',' ') ///< Generic error in an external library
+#define AVERROR_FILTER_NOT_FOUND   FFERRTAG(0xF8,'F','I','L') ///< Filter not found
+#define AVERROR_INVALIDDATA        FFERRTAG( 'I','N','D','A') ///< Invalid data found when processing input
+#define AVERROR_MUXER_NOT_FOUND    FFERRTAG(0xF8,'M','U','X') ///< Muxer not found
+#define AVERROR_OPTION_NOT_FOUND   FFERRTAG(0xF8,'O','P','T') ///< Option not found
+#define AVERROR_PATCHWELCOME       FFERRTAG( 'P','A','W','E') ///< Not yet implemented in FFmpeg, patches welcome
+#define AVERROR_PROTOCOL_NOT_FOUND FFERRTAG(0xF8,'P','R','O') ///< Protocol not found
+
+#define AVERROR_STREAM_NOT_FOUND   FFERRTAG(0xF8,'S','T','R') ///< Stream not found
+/**
+ * This is semantically identical to AVERROR_BUG
+ * it has been introduced in Libav after our AVERROR_BUG and with a modified value.
+ */
+#define AVERROR_BUG2               FFERRTAG( 'B','U','G',' ')
+#define AVERROR_UNKNOWN            FFERRTAG( 'U','N','K','N') ///< Unknown error, typically from an external library
+#define AVERROR_EXPERIMENTAL       (-0x2bb2afa8) ///< Requested feature is flagged experimental. Set strict_std_compliance if you really want to use it.
+#define AVERROR_INPUT_CHANGED      (-0x636e6701) ///< Input changed between calls. Reconfiguration is required. (can be OR-ed with AVERROR_OUTPUT_CHANGED)
+#define AVERROR_OUTPUT_CHANGED     (-0x636e6702) ///< Output changed between calls. Reconfiguration is required. (can be OR-ed with AVERROR_INPUT_CHANGED)
+/* HTTP & RTSP errors */
+#define AVERROR_HTTP_BAD_REQUEST   FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','0')
+#define AVERROR_HTTP_UNAUTHORIZED  FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','1')
+#define AVERROR_HTTP_FORBIDDEN     FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','3')
+#define AVERROR_HTTP_NOT_FOUND     FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','0','4')
+#define AVERROR_HTTP_OTHER_4XX     FFERRTAG(0xF8,'4','X','X')
+#define AVERROR_HTTP_SERVER_ERROR  FFERRTAG(0xF8,'5','X','X')
+
+#define AV_ERROR_MAX_STRING_SIZE 64
+
+/**
+ * Put a description of the AVERROR code errnum in errbuf.
+ * In case of failure the global variable errno is set to indicate the
+ * error. Even in case of failure av_strerror() will print a generic
+ * error message indicating the errnum provided to errbuf.
+ *
+ * @param errnum      error code to describe
+ * @param errbuf      buffer to which description is written
+ * @param errbuf_size the size in bytes of errbuf
+ * @return 0 on success, a negative value if a description for errnum
+ * cannot be found
+ */
+int av_strerror(int errnum, char *errbuf, size_t errbuf_size);
+
+/**
+ * Fill the provided buffer with a string containing an error string
+ * corresponding to the AVERROR code errnum.
+ *
+ * @param errbuf         a buffer
+ * @param errbuf_size    size in bytes of errbuf
+ * @param errnum         error code to describe
+ * @return the buffer in input, filled with the error description
+ * @see av_strerror()
+ */
+static inline char *av_make_error_string(char *errbuf, size_t errbuf_size, int errnum)
+{
+    av_strerror(errnum, errbuf, errbuf_size);
+    return errbuf;
+}
+
+/**
+ * Convenience macro, the return value should be used only directly in
+ * function arguments but never stand-alone.
+ */
+#define av_err2str(errnum) \
+    av_make_error_string((char[AV_ERROR_MAX_STRING_SIZE]){0}, AV_ERROR_MAX_STRING_SIZE, errnum)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#endif /* AVUTIL_ERROR_H */
new file mode 100644
--- /dev/null
+++ b/dom/media/platforms/ffmpeg/ffmpeg58/include/libavutil/frame.h
@@ -0,0 +1,893 @@
+/*
+ * This file is part of FFmpeg.